1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.75"
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>06 May 2011</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.77</revnumber>
178 <date>10 Oct 2011</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2011</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
743 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
773 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1650 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1651 .cindex "PCRE library"
1652 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1653 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1654 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1655 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1656 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1657 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1658 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1659 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1660 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1662 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1663 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1664 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1665 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1666 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1667 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1668 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1670 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1671 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1672 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1673 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1674 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1675 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1676 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1677 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1679 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1680 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1681 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1682 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1683 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1684 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1685 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1686 Berkeley DB library.
1688 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1689 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1693 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1694 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1696 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1697 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1698 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1699 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1700 file name is used unmodified.
1702 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1703 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1704 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1705 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1707 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1708 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1709 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1711 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1712 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1713 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1714 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1715 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1716 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1718 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1719 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1720 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1721 operates on a single file.
1725 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1726 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1727 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1728 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1729 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1733 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1734 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1736 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1737 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1738 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1739 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1740 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1741 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1743 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1744 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1745 in one of these lines:
1750 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1751 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1752 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1753 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1756 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1757 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1759 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1760 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1764 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1765 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1766 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1767 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1768 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1769 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1770 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1771 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1772 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1773 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1774 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1775 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1777 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1778 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1779 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1780 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1781 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1782 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1784 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1785 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1786 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1787 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1788 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1789 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1792 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1793 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1794 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1795 facilities, you need to set
1797 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1799 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1800 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1803 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1804 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1805 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1806 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1807 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1808 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1809 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1811 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1812 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1813 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1814 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1815 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1820 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1821 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1823 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1824 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1825 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1826 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1827 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1828 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1829 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1831 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1832 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1833 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1834 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1835 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1839 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1843 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1844 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1845 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1846 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1847 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1848 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1849 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1850 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1851 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1852 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1855 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1856 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1859 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1862 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1864 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1865 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1868 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1869 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1872 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1873 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1876 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1879 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1880 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1884 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1886 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1887 library and include files. For example:
1891 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1892 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1895 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1896 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1900 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1904 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1905 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1906 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1911 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1913 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1914 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1915 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1916 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1917 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1918 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1919 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1920 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1921 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1922 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1923 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1924 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1927 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1928 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1929 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1931 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1932 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1934 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1936 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1937 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1938 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1939 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1940 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1941 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1945 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1946 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1947 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1948 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1949 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1950 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1953 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1954 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1955 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1956 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1957 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1958 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1959 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1960 support has not been tested for some time.
1964 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1965 .cindex "lookup modules"
1966 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1967 .cindex ".so building"
1968 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1969 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1971 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1972 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1974 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1976 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1977 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1978 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1979 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1980 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1981 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1983 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1984 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1985 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1994 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1995 .cindex "build directory"
1996 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1997 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1998 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1999 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2000 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2001 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2002 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2004 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2005 building process fails if it is set.
2007 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2008 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2009 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2010 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2011 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2012 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2013 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2014 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2016 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2017 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2018 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2022 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2023 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2024 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2025 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2026 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2027 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2028 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2032 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2033 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2034 given in addition to the short output.
2038 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2039 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2040 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2041 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2042 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2043 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2044 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2047 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2048 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2050 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2051 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2052 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2053 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2055 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2056 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2057 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2058 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2059 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2060 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2061 and are often not needed.
2063 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2064 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2065 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2066 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2067 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2068 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2069 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2070 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2071 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2075 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2076 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2077 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2081 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2082 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2083 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2084 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2085 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2086 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2087 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2088 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2089 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2090 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2091 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2092 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2093 containing the lines
2098 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2099 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2101 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2102 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2103 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2106 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2107 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2108 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2109 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2110 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2111 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2112 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2113 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2114 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2115 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2121 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2122 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2123 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2124 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2125 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2126 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2127 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2128 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2132 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2133 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2134 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2135 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2136 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2137 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2138 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2139 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2140 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2141 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2142 syntax. For instance:
2145 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2147 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2148 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2149 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2153 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2154 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2155 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2159 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2160 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2162 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2163 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2164 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2165 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2166 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2167 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2170 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2171 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2173 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2174 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2177 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2178 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2180 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2181 definition of all three of these variables into your
2182 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2185 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2186 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2187 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2188 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2190 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2191 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2192 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2193 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2194 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2197 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2198 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2199 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2200 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2201 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2204 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2206 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2207 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2208 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2209 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2210 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2211 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2215 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2216 .cindex "building Eximon"
2217 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2218 where the files that are involved are
2220 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2221 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2222 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2223 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2224 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2225 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2227 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2228 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2229 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2230 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2231 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2232 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2233 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2237 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2238 .cindex "installing Exim"
2239 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2240 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2241 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2242 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2243 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2244 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2245 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2246 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2247 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2248 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2249 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2250 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2252 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2253 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2254 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2255 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2256 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2257 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2258 alternative files, no default is installed.
2260 .cindex "system aliases file"
2261 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2262 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2263 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2264 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2265 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2266 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2267 and outputs a comment to the user.
2269 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2270 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2271 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2272 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2273 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2275 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2276 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2277 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2278 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2279 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2282 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2283 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2286 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2288 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2289 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2290 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2291 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2292 but this usage is deprecated.
2294 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2295 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2296 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2297 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2298 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2299 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2301 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2302 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2303 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2304 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2305 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2306 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2307 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2309 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2310 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2311 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2314 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2316 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2317 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2318 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2319 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2322 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2324 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2325 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2328 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2329 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2331 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2335 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2337 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2339 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2340 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2341 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2343 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2348 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2349 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2350 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2351 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2352 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2355 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2356 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2357 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2361 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2362 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2363 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2364 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2365 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2371 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2372 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2373 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2374 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2375 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2379 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2380 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2381 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2382 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2383 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2386 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2388 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2390 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2392 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2393 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2394 user agent. For example:
2396 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2397 From: user@your.domain.example
2398 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2399 Subject: Testing Exim
2401 This is a test message.
2404 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2405 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2406 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2408 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2409 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2410 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2411 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2412 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2413 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2415 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2417 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2418 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2419 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2420 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2421 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2423 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2424 .cindex "lock files"
2425 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2426 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2427 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2428 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2429 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2430 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2431 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2432 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2433 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2434 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2435 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2436 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2438 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2439 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2440 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2441 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2442 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2445 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2446 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2447 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2448 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2452 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2453 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2454 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2455 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2456 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2457 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2458 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2459 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2460 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2461 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2462 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2463 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2464 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2466 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2467 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2468 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2469 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2470 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2471 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2474 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2475 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2476 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2477 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2479 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2480 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2481 favourite user agent.
2483 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2484 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2485 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2486 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2487 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2488 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2492 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2493 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2494 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2495 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2496 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2497 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2498 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2499 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2505 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2506 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2507 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2509 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2511 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2512 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2513 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2514 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2515 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2517 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2519 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2521 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2522 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2523 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2531 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2532 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2533 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2534 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2535 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2536 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2537 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2538 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2539 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2542 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2544 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2545 were present before any other options.
2546 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2548 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2549 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2550 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2553 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2554 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2555 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2559 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2560 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2561 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2564 .cindex "queue runner"
2565 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2566 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2567 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2569 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2570 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2571 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2573 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2574 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2575 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2576 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2579 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2580 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2581 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2582 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2583 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2584 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2587 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2588 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2589 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2590 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2591 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2592 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2594 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2595 .cindex "envelope sender"
2596 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2597 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2598 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2599 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2600 users to set envelope senders.
2602 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2603 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2604 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2605 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2606 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2608 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2609 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2610 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2611 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2612 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2613 that are available to trusted users.
2615 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2616 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2617 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2618 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2619 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2621 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2622 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2623 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2624 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2626 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2627 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2628 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2629 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2631 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2632 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2637 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2638 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2639 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2645 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2646 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2647 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2648 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2649 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2650 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2651 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2652 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2655 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2656 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2657 . creates a man page for the options.
2658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2661 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2668 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2669 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2670 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2671 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2674 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2675 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2676 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2679 .vitem &%--version%&
2680 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2681 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2684 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2686 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2687 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2688 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2689 clean; it ignores this option.
2694 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2695 .cindex "queue runner"
2696 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2697 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2698 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2700 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2701 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2702 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2703 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2705 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2706 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2707 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2708 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2710 When a listening daemon
2711 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2712 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2713 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2714 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2715 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2716 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2719 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2720 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2721 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2725 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2726 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2727 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2728 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2729 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2730 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2731 because these are reread each time they are used.
2735 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2736 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2740 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2741 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2742 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2743 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2744 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2745 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2747 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2748 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2749 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2750 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2751 test data. A line history is supported.
2753 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2754 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2755 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2756 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2757 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2758 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2759 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2761 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2762 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2763 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2764 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2766 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2771 of a file. For example:
2773 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2775 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2776 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2777 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2778 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2779 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2780 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2781 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2784 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2786 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2787 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2788 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2789 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2790 system filters are recognized.
2792 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2794 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2795 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2796 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2797 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2798 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2799 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2800 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2801 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2804 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2805 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2806 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2808 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2810 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2811 variables that are used by the user filter.
2813 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2818 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2819 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2820 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2823 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2824 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2825 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2826 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2828 When testing a filter file,
2829 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2830 .cindex "envelope sender"
2831 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2832 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2833 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2834 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2835 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2838 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2840 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2841 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2842 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2845 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2847 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2848 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2849 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2850 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2851 actually being delivered.
2853 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2855 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2856 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2859 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2861 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2862 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2865 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2867 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2868 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2869 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2870 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2871 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2872 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2873 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2874 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2875 after a full stop. For example:
2877 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2878 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2880 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2881 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2882 conversion to the canonical form is
2883 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2885 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2886 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2887 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2888 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2889 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2893 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2894 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2895 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2898 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2899 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2900 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2902 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2903 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2904 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2905 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2906 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2907 session were authenticated.
2909 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2910 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2911 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2913 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2914 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2915 specialized SMTP test program such as
2916 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2918 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2920 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2921 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2922 updating the callout cache database.
2926 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2927 .cindex "building alias file"
2928 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2929 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2930 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2931 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2932 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2935 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2936 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2937 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2938 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2939 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2940 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2945 .cindex "local message reception"
2946 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2947 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2948 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2949 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2950 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2951 if no other conflicting option is present.
2953 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2954 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2955 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2956 suppressing this for special cases.
2958 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2959 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2961 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2962 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2963 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2966 .cindex "message" "format"
2967 .cindex "format" "message"
2968 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2969 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2970 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2971 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2972 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2974 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2975 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2977 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2978 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2979 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2980 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2981 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2983 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2984 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2985 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2986 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2987 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2991 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2992 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2993 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2994 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2995 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2996 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2997 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2999 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3000 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3001 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3002 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3003 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3005 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3006 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3007 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3008 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3013 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3014 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3015 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3016 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3017 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3018 arguments, for example:
3020 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3022 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3023 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3024 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3025 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3026 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3027 users, the output is as in this example:
3029 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3031 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3032 configuration file is output.
3033 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3034 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3036 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3037 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3038 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3039 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3040 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3041 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3042 written directly into the spool directory.
3044 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3046 exim -bP +local_domains
3048 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3049 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3051 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3052 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3053 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3054 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3055 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3056 that driver are output. For example:
3058 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3060 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3061 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3062 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3063 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3064 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3067 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3068 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3069 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3070 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3071 The output format is one item per line.
3075 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3076 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3077 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3078 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3079 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3080 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3081 to allow any user to see the queue.
3083 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3085 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3086 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3089 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3090 .cindex "size" "of message"
3091 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3092 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3093 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3094 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3095 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3096 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3097 before the sender address.
3099 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3100 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3101 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3103 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3104 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3105 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3106 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3107 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3113 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3114 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3115 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3121 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3122 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3123 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3124 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3129 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3130 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3131 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3132 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3136 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3140 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3145 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3146 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3147 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3148 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3153 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3154 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3155 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3156 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3157 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3159 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3160 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3162 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3163 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3164 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3165 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3166 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3167 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3168 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3169 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3170 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3172 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3173 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3178 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3179 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3180 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3181 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3182 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3183 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3184 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3188 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3189 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3190 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3191 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3192 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3193 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3194 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3195 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3196 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3198 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3199 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3200 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3202 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3203 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3204 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3205 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3207 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3208 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3209 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3211 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3212 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3213 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3214 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3215 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3217 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3218 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3222 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3223 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3224 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3225 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3226 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3227 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3228 messages to the MTA.
3231 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3232 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3233 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3234 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3235 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3236 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3237 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3241 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3242 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3243 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3244 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3245 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3246 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3247 the listening daemon.
3249 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3250 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3251 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3252 .cindex "malware scan test"
3253 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3254 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3255 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3256 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3257 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3258 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3260 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3261 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3262 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3263 This option requires admin privileges.
3265 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3266 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3267 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3271 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3272 .cindex "address" "testing"
3273 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3274 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3275 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3276 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3277 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3279 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3280 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3282 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3283 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3286 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3287 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3288 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3289 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3290 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3293 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3294 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3295 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3296 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3298 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3299 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3300 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3301 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3304 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3305 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3307 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3308 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3309 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3310 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3311 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3312 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3317 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3318 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3319 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3320 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3321 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3322 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3324 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3325 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3326 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3327 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3328 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3329 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3330 dynamic testing facilities.
3334 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3335 .cindex "address" "verification"
3336 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3337 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3338 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3339 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3340 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3341 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3343 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3344 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3345 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3347 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3348 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3350 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3351 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3354 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3355 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3356 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3357 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3358 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3360 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3361 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3362 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3363 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3364 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3365 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3368 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3369 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3370 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3373 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3374 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3375 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3376 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3378 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3379 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3380 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3381 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3385 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3386 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3389 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3391 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3392 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3393 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3394 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3395 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3396 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3397 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3398 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3399 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3401 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3402 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3403 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3404 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3405 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3406 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3407 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3408 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3409 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3411 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3412 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3413 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3414 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3415 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3416 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3417 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3419 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3420 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3421 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3422 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3423 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3424 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3425 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3427 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3428 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3429 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3432 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3433 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3434 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3435 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3436 specified by this option.
3439 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3441 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3442 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3443 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3444 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3445 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3446 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3448 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3449 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3450 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3451 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3452 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3453 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3454 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3456 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3457 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3458 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3464 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3465 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3468 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3470 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3473 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3475 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3476 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3477 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3478 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3479 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3480 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3481 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3484 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3485 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3486 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3487 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3488 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3489 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3490 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3493 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3494 &`auth `& authenticators
3495 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3496 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3497 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3498 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3499 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3500 &`filter `& filter handling
3501 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3502 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3503 &`ident `& ident lookup
3504 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3505 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3506 &`load `& system load checks
3507 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3508 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3509 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3510 &`memory `& memory handling
3511 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3512 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3513 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3514 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3515 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3516 &`retry `& retry handling
3517 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3518 &`route `& address routing
3519 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3521 &`transport `& transports
3522 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3523 &`verify `& address verification logic
3524 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3526 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3527 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3528 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3529 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3530 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3531 turn everything off.
3533 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3534 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3535 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3536 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3537 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3540 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3541 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3542 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3543 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3544 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3547 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3548 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3551 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3552 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3554 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3556 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3557 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3558 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3559 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3562 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3563 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3564 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3565 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3569 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3570 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3571 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3572 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3573 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3574 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3575 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3576 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3579 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3580 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3581 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3582 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3583 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3585 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3587 .cindex "sender" "name"
3588 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3589 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3590 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3591 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3592 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3593 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3595 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3597 .cindex "sender" "address"
3598 .cindex "address" "sender"
3599 .cindex "trusted users"
3600 .cindex "envelope sender"
3601 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3602 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3603 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3604 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3607 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3608 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3609 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3610 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3613 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3614 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3615 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3616 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3617 examples of shell commands:
3619 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3620 exim -f "" user@domain
3622 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3623 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3626 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3627 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3628 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3629 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3632 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3633 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3634 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3635 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3636 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3637 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3641 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3642 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3644 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3646 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3647 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3648 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3653 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3654 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3655 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3656 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3657 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3658 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3660 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3662 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3663 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3664 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3665 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3666 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3667 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3668 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3671 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3672 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3673 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3674 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3675 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3676 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3678 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3679 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3680 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3681 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3683 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3685 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3686 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3687 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3688 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3689 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3690 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3691 can be used only by an admin user.
3693 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3694 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3696 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3697 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3698 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3699 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3700 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3701 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3702 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3703 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3707 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3708 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3709 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3713 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3714 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3715 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3717 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3719 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3720 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3721 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3722 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3723 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3724 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3728 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3729 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3730 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3735 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3736 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3737 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3739 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3741 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3742 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3743 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3744 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3745 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3746 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3747 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3748 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3749 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3750 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3751 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3752 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3753 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3755 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3757 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3758 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3759 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3760 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3761 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3762 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3763 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3764 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3766 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3768 .cindex "freezing messages"
3769 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3770 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3771 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3772 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3773 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3774 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3777 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3779 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3780 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3781 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3782 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3783 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3784 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3785 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3786 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3789 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3791 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3792 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3793 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3794 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3795 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3797 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3799 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3800 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3801 .cindex "removing recipients"
3802 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3803 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3804 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3805 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3806 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3807 can be used only by an admin user.
3809 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3811 .cindex "removing messages"
3812 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3813 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3814 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3815 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3816 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3817 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3818 placed on the queue.
3820 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3822 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3823 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3824 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3825 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3826 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3827 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3828 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3829 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3830 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3832 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3834 .cindex "thawing messages"
3835 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3836 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3837 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3838 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3839 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3840 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3843 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3845 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3846 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3847 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3848 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3850 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3852 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3853 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3854 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3855 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3856 only by an admin user.
3858 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3860 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3861 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3862 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3863 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3864 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3866 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3868 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3869 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3870 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3871 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3875 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3876 treats it that way too.
3880 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3881 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3882 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3883 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3884 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3885 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3886 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3889 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3890 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3891 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3892 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3893 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3894 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3895 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3900 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3901 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3904 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3906 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3909 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3911 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3912 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3913 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3916 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3918 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3919 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3920 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3921 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3922 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3923 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3927 .cindex "background delivery"
3928 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3929 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3930 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3931 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3932 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3933 processes to finish.
3935 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3936 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3937 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3938 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3940 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3941 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3942 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3943 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3947 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3948 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3949 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3950 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3951 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3952 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3954 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3955 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3958 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3959 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3961 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3962 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3963 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3964 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3969 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3974 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3975 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3976 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3977 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3978 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3979 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3980 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3981 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3982 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3983 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3988 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3989 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3990 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3991 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3992 configuration file is in effect.
3994 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3995 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3996 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3997 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3998 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3999 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4000 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4001 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4002 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4007 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4008 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4009 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4012 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4014 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4015 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4016 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4017 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4021 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4022 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4023 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4024 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4025 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4029 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4030 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4031 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4032 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4033 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4037 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4038 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4043 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4044 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4049 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4050 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4051 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4052 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4053 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4054 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4057 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4058 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4060 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4062 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4063 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4064 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4065 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4066 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4067 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4069 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4070 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4072 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4074 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4075 followed by a colon and the port number:
4077 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4079 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4080 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4081 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4082 whichever one is last.
4084 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4086 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4087 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4088 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4089 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4090 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4091 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4093 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4095 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4096 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4097 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4098 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4099 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4100 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4102 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4104 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4105 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4106 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4107 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4108 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4109 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4110 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4111 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4113 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4115 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4116 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4117 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4118 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4119 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4121 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4123 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4124 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4125 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4126 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4127 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4128 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4129 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4130 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4131 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4134 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4136 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4137 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4138 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4139 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4140 uses the name it is given.
4142 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4144 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4145 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4146 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4147 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4148 used, when there is no default.
4152 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4153 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4154 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4155 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4159 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4160 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4161 whatever that means.
4163 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4165 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4166 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4167 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4168 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4169 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4170 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4171 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4173 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4175 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4176 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4177 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4178 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4179 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4181 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4183 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4184 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4185 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4186 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4187 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4188 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4192 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4194 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4196 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4197 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4198 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4199 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4200 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4201 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4202 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4203 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4207 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4208 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4209 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4210 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4215 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4216 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4217 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4218 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4221 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4223 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4225 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4227 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4228 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4229 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4230 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4231 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4235 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4236 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4237 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4238 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4239 and &%-S%& options).
4241 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4242 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4243 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4244 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4245 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4246 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4249 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4250 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4251 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4252 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4253 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4256 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4257 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4258 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4259 this to be repeated periodically.
4261 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4262 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4263 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4264 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4266 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4267 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4268 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4270 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4271 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4272 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4273 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4277 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4278 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4279 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4280 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4281 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4282 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4285 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4286 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4287 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4288 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4289 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4290 delivered down a single SMTP
4291 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4292 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4293 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4294 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4295 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4298 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4300 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4301 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4302 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4303 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4304 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4306 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4308 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4309 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4310 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4311 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4312 their retry times are tried.
4314 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4316 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4317 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4320 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4322 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4323 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4324 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4327 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4328 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4329 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4330 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4331 starting message id. For example:
4333 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4335 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4336 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4337 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4339 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4341 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4342 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4343 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4344 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4345 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4346 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4348 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4349 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4350 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4351 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4352 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4353 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4354 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4355 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4356 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4358 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4360 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4361 process every 30 minutes.
4363 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4364 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4366 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4368 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4371 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4373 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4375 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4377 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4378 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4379 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4380 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4381 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4382 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4383 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4385 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4386 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4387 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4388 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4389 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4390 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4392 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4393 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4395 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4397 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4398 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4399 applied to each queue run.
4401 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4402 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4403 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4404 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4405 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4406 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4407 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4408 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4409 address will be skipped.
4411 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4412 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4413 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4416 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4417 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4418 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4419 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4420 an arbitrary command instead.
4424 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4426 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4428 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4429 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4430 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4431 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4432 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4433 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4435 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4437 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4438 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4439 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4443 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4444 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4445 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4446 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4447 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4448 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4449 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4450 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4451 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4453 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4454 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4455 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4456 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4457 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4458 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4459 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4460 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4461 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4462 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4463 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4465 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4466 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4467 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4468 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4469 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4470 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4472 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4473 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4474 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4475 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4476 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4477 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4478 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4479 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4480 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4484 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4485 compatibility with Sendmail.
4487 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4488 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4489 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4490 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4491 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4492 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4493 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4494 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4499 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4500 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4501 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4502 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4503 set. Exim ignores this option.
4507 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4508 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4509 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4510 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4511 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4512 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4517 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4518 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4519 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4528 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4529 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4530 . creates a man page for the options.
4531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4534 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4545 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4546 "The runtime configuration file"
4548 .cindex "run time configuration"
4549 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4550 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4551 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4552 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4553 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4554 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4555 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4556 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4559 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4560 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4561 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4562 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4563 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4564 actually alter the string.
4566 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4567 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4568 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4569 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4570 existing file in the list.
4573 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4574 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4575 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4576 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4577 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4578 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4579 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4580 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4581 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4582 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4584 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4585 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4586 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4587 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4588 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4590 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4591 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4592 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4593 compromise the Exim user account.
4595 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4596 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4597 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4598 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4599 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4600 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4605 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4606 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4607 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4608 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4609 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4610 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4611 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4612 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4613 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4614 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4615 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4617 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4618 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4619 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4620 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4621 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4622 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4623 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4624 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4625 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4628 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4629 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4630 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4631 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4632 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4634 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4635 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4636 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4637 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4638 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4639 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4641 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4642 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4643 necessarily be discarded.
4644 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4645 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4646 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4647 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4648 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4649 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4651 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4652 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4653 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4654 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4655 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4656 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4657 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4659 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4660 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4661 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4665 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4666 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4667 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4668 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4669 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4670 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4671 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4675 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4678 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4679 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4680 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4682 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4683 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4684 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4686 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4687 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4688 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4690 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4691 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4692 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4693 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4696 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4697 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4698 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4700 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4701 want to use this feature, you must set
4703 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4705 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4706 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4709 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4710 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4711 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4712 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4714 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4715 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4716 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4717 and does not introduce a comment.
4719 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4720 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4721 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4722 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4723 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4725 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4726 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4727 change settings as required.
4729 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4730 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4731 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4732 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4733 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4738 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4739 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4740 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4741 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4742 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4743 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4746 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4747 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4749 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4750 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4751 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4754 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4755 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4756 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4757 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4759 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4760 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4763 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4766 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4767 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4772 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4773 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4775 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4776 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4777 definition, and must be of the form
4779 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4781 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4782 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4783 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4784 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4785 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4787 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4788 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4789 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4791 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4792 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4793 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4794 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4795 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4796 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4797 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4800 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4801 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4803 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4804 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4805 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4806 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4807 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4808 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4811 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4812 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4813 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4818 MAC == updated value
4820 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4821 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4822 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4823 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4827 MAC == MAC and something added
4829 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4830 from a number of other files.
4832 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4833 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4834 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4835 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4836 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4841 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4842 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4843 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4844 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4846 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4847 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4849 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4851 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4853 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4854 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4855 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4858 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4859 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4860 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4861 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4862 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4863 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4864 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4866 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4867 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4868 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4872 message_size_limit = 50M
4874 message_size_limit = 100M
4877 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4878 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4879 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4880 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4882 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4883 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4884 in this line"& will always be true.
4886 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4887 to clarify complicated nestings.
4891 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4892 .cindex "common option syntax"
4893 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4894 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4895 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4896 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4897 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4898 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4899 space) and then the value. For example:
4901 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4903 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4904 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4905 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4906 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4907 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4908 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4909 word &"hide"&. For example:
4911 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4913 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4915 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4917 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4918 all instances of the same driver.
4920 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4921 that are found in option settings.
4924 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4925 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4926 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4927 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4928 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4929 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4930 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4931 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4932 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4933 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4934 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4935 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4940 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4945 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4950 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4951 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4952 .cindex "format" "integer"
4953 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4954 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4955 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4956 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4959 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4960 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4961 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4962 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4963 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4967 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4968 .cindex "integer format"
4969 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4970 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4971 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4972 Such options are always output in octal.
4975 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4976 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4977 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4978 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4979 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4983 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4984 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4985 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4986 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4987 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4997 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4998 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4999 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5003 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5004 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5005 .cindex "format" "string"
5006 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5007 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5008 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5009 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5010 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5011 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5012 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5013 therefore equivalent:
5015 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5016 trusted_users = uucp:\
5017 # This comment line is ignored
5020 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5021 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5022 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5023 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5024 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5027 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5028 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5029 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5031 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5032 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5036 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5037 character, that character replaces the pair.
5039 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5040 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5041 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5042 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5043 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5044 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5047 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5048 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5049 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5050 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5051 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5052 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5053 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5054 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5055 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5056 within a quoted configuration string.
5059 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5060 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5061 .cindex "format" "user name"
5062 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5063 .cindex "format" "group name"
5064 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5065 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5066 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5067 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5070 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5071 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5072 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5073 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5074 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5075 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5076 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5077 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5078 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5079 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5080 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5082 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5083 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5084 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5085 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5086 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5087 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5090 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5092 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5094 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5095 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5096 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5097 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5099 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5100 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5101 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5102 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5103 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5104 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5105 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5106 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5108 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5110 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5111 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5112 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5114 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5115 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5116 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5117 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5118 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5119 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5120 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5121 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5122 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5124 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5126 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5127 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5128 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5129 the value in quotes. For example:
5131 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5133 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5134 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5135 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5136 enclosing an empty list item.
5140 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5141 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5142 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5143 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5145 senders = user@domain :
5147 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5148 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5149 items, the second of which is empty:
5151 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5153 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5154 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5155 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5156 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5160 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5161 is at the end of the list.
5166 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5167 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5168 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5169 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5170 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5171 a sequence of lines like this:
5173 <&'instance name'&>:
5178 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5179 followed by three options settings:
5184 transport = local_delivery
5186 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5187 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5188 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5189 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5190 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5191 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5193 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5194 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5196 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5197 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5198 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5199 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5200 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5203 .cindex "generic options"
5204 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5205 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5206 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5207 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5208 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5209 .cindex "private options"
5210 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5211 they all have default values.
5213 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5214 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5215 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5217 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5218 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5219 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5220 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5221 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5222 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5223 configuration lines:
5228 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5229 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5230 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5231 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5237 command_timeout = 10s
5239 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5240 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5243 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5244 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5245 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5254 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5256 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5257 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5258 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5259 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5260 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5261 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5262 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5263 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5264 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5265 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5266 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5270 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5271 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5272 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5275 # primary_hostname =
5277 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5278 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5279 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5280 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5282 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5284 domainlist local_domains = @
5285 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5286 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5288 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5289 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5290 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5291 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5293 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5294 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5297 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5298 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5299 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5300 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5301 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5302 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5304 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5305 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5306 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5307 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5308 domain is permitted.
5310 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5311 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5312 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5313 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5314 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5315 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5317 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5318 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5319 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5321 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5323 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5324 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5326 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5327 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5328 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5329 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5330 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5331 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5332 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5333 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5334 contents of a message to be checked.
5336 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5338 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5339 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5341 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5342 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5343 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5344 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5346 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5348 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5349 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5350 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5352 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5353 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5354 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5355 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5356 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5357 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5358 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5360 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5362 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5363 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5365 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5366 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5367 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5368 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5369 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5370 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5371 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5372 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5373 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5374 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5375 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5376 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5377 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5378 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5379 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5380 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5382 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5385 # qualify_recipient =
5387 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5388 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5389 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5390 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5391 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5392 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5394 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5395 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5396 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5397 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5399 # allow_domain_literals
5401 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5402 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5403 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5404 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5405 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5406 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5408 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5412 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5413 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5414 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5415 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5416 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5417 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5418 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5419 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5421 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5422 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5427 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5428 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5429 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5430 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5431 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5432 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5435 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5436 1413 (hence their names):
5439 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5441 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5442 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5443 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5444 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5445 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5446 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5447 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5449 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5450 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5451 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5452 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5454 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5455 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5457 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5458 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5460 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5462 # percent_hack_domains =
5464 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5465 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5466 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5468 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5469 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5470 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5471 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5472 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5473 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5474 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5475 always bounce messages.
5477 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5478 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5480 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5481 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5482 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5483 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5484 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5488 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5489 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5490 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5491 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5492 It starts with the line
5496 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5497 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5498 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5500 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5501 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5502 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5503 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5504 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5505 result of the ACL processing.
5509 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5514 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5515 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5516 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5517 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5518 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5519 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5521 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5522 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5523 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5526 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5527 domains = +local_domains
5528 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5530 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5531 domains = !+local_domains
5532 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5534 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5535 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5536 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5537 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5538 in Internet mail addresses.
5540 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5541 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5542 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5543 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5544 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5545 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5546 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5547 policy of being as safe as possible.
5549 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5550 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5551 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5552 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5553 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5554 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5556 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5557 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5558 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5559 have to modify this rule.
5561 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5562 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5563 common convention of local parts constructed as
5564 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5565 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5566 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5567 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5568 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5569 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5571 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5572 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5573 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5574 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5575 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5576 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5577 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5579 accept local_parts = postmaster
5580 domains = +local_domains
5582 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5583 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5584 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5585 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5586 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5588 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5589 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5590 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5592 require verify = sender
5594 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5595 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5596 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5597 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5598 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5599 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5600 discusses the details of address verification.
5602 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5603 control = submission
5605 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5606 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5607 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5608 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5609 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5610 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5611 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5612 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5613 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5615 accept authenticated = *
5616 control = submission
5618 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5619 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5620 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5621 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5622 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5623 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5625 require message = relay not permitted
5626 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5628 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5629 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5631 require verify = recipient
5633 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5634 fails, the address is rejected.
5636 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5637 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5639 # dnslists = black.list.example
5641 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5642 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5643 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5644 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5646 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5647 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5648 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5651 # require verify = csa
5653 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5654 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5659 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5660 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5664 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5665 of this ACL are commented out:
5668 # message = This message contains a virus \
5671 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5672 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5673 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5674 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5676 # warn spam = nobody
5677 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5678 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5679 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5680 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5682 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5683 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5684 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5685 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5686 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5687 whatever the spam score.
5691 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5694 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5695 .cindex "default" "routers"
5696 .cindex "routers" "default"
5697 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5702 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5703 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5704 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5705 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5706 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5709 # driver = ipliteral
5710 # domains = !+local_domains
5711 # transport = remote_smtp
5713 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5714 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5715 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5716 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5717 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5721 domains = ! +local_domains
5722 transport = remote_smtp
5723 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5726 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5727 domains. This is specified by the line
5729 domains = ! +local_domains
5731 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5732 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5733 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5734 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5735 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5736 passed on to the following routers.
5738 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5739 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5740 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5741 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5742 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5744 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5745 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5746 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5747 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5748 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5749 the address fails and is bounced.
5751 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5752 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5753 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5754 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5755 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5756 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5757 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5764 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5766 file_transport = address_file
5767 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5769 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5770 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5771 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5772 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5773 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5776 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5777 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5778 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5779 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5784 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5785 # local_part_suffix_optional
5786 file = $home/.forward
5791 file_transport = address_file
5792 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5793 reply_transport = address_reply
5795 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5796 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5797 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5798 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5799 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5802 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5803 # local_part_suffix_optional
5805 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5806 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5807 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5808 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5809 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5810 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5811 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5813 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5814 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5815 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5816 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5818 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5819 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5820 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5821 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5822 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5823 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5824 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5826 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5827 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5828 There are two reasons for doing this:
5831 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5832 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5835 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5836 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5837 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5838 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5842 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5843 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5844 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5845 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5847 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5848 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5849 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5851 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5853 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5859 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5860 # local_part_suffix_optional
5861 transport = local_delivery
5863 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5864 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5865 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5866 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5867 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5870 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5871 .cindex "default" "transports"
5872 .cindex "transports" "default"
5873 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5874 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5875 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5879 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5884 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5885 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5889 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5896 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5897 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5898 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5899 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5900 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5901 show how this can be done.
5903 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5904 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5905 similarly-named options above.
5911 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5912 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5913 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5922 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5923 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5924 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5929 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5934 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5935 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5936 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5937 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5938 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5939 introduced by the line
5943 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5946 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5948 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5949 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5950 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5951 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5953 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5954 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5955 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5958 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5959 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5963 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5964 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5968 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5969 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5970 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5972 begin authenticators
5974 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5975 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5976 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5977 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5978 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5979 to support most MUA software.
5981 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5984 # driver = plaintext
5985 # server_set_id = $auth2
5986 # server_prompts = :
5987 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5988 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5990 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5993 # driver = plaintext
5994 # server_set_id = $auth1
5995 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5996 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5997 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6000 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6001 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6002 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6003 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6004 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6005 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6006 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6007 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6009 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6010 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6011 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6012 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6014 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6015 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
6018 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6022 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6023 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6025 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6027 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6029 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6030 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6031 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6032 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6033 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6034 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6036 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6037 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6038 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6039 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6040 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6043 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6044 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6045 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6046 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6048 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6050 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6051 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6052 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6053 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6054 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6055 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6058 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6059 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6060 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6061 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6062 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6063 match anywhere in the subject string.
6065 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6066 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6068 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6070 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6073 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6075 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6076 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6080 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6083 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6084 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6085 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6086 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6087 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6088 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6091 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6092 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6093 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6094 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6095 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6097 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6098 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6099 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6100 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6101 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6104 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6105 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6106 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6107 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6108 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6109 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6111 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6112 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6113 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6114 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6115 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6117 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6118 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6120 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6121 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6122 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6123 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6124 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6126 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6127 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6129 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6130 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6132 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6133 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6134 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6139 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6140 matches the list item.
6142 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6143 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6145 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6147 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6148 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6149 causes a second lookup to occur.
6151 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6152 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6153 lookup is permitted.
6156 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6157 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6158 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6159 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6162 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6163 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6164 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6166 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6167 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6168 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6169 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6172 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6173 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6174 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6179 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6180 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6181 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6186 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6187 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6188 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6189 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6192 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6193 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6194 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6195 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6196 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6197 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6198 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6199 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6200 be found in several places:
6202 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6203 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6204 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6206 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6207 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6208 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6209 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6211 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6212 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6213 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6214 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6215 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6216 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6217 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6219 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6220 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6221 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6222 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6223 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6224 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6225 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6228 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6229 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6231 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6232 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6233 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6234 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6235 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6236 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6237 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6240 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6241 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6242 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6244 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6245 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6246 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6247 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6248 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6249 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6250 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6251 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6252 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6253 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6255 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6256 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6257 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6258 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6259 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6260 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6261 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6262 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6263 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6265 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6266 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6267 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6268 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6269 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6270 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6271 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6273 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6274 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6275 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6276 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6278 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6279 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6280 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6281 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6282 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6284 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6285 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6286 lookup types support only literal keys.
6288 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6289 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6290 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6292 .cindex "linear search"
6293 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6294 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6295 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6296 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6297 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6298 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6299 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6300 in the file is used.
6302 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6303 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6304 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6305 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6306 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6311 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6312 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6313 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6314 wildcarding of any kind.
6316 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6317 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6318 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6319 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6320 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6321 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6322 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6323 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6324 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6327 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6328 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6329 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6330 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6331 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6332 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6333 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6334 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6337 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6338 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6339 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6341 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6342 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6343 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6344 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6345 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6347 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6348 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6349 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6350 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6352 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6353 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6356 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6358 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6359 *fish data for anythingfish
6362 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6363 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6365 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6367 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6368 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6369 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6371 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6373 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6374 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6375 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6377 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6380 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6381 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6382 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6383 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6384 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6386 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6387 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6388 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6389 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6390 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6393 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6394 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6395 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6398 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6400 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6403 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6404 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6405 be followed by optional colons.
6407 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6408 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6409 lookup types support only literal keys.
6413 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6414 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6415 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6416 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6417 many of them are given in later sections.
6420 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6421 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6422 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6423 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6424 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6426 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6427 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6428 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6430 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6431 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6432 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6433 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6434 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6435 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6436 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6438 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6439 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6440 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6441 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6443 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6445 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6446 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6448 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6449 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6450 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6451 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6453 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6454 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6455 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6456 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6457 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6458 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6459 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6460 password value. For example:
6462 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6465 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6466 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6467 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6468 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6471 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6472 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6473 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6474 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6477 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6478 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6480 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6481 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6482 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6483 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6484 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6485 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6486 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6487 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6488 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6490 require condition = \
6491 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6493 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6494 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6495 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6496 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6501 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6502 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6503 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6504 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6505 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6506 options such as a list of local domains.
6508 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6509 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6510 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6511 or may give up altogether.
6515 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6516 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6517 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6518 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6519 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6520 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6521 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6522 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6524 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6525 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6526 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6528 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6529 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6530 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6532 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6533 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6534 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6535 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6536 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6537 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6538 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6539 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6540 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6541 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6543 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6545 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6546 looks up these keys, in this order:
6552 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6553 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6554 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6555 Exim move on to try the next key.
6559 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6560 .cindex "partial matching"
6561 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6562 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6563 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6564 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6565 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6566 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6567 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6568 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6569 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6570 a key in a DBM file is
6572 *.dates.fict.example
6574 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6575 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6576 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6579 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6580 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6581 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6583 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6584 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6585 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6586 partial matching keys
6587 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6588 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6589 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6591 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6592 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6593 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6594 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6595 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6596 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6599 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6600 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6601 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6602 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6603 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6604 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6606 2250.dates.fict.example
6607 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6608 *.dates.fict.example
6611 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6614 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6615 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6616 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6617 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6618 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6619 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6621 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6623 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6624 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6625 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6626 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6628 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6630 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6631 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6633 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6634 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6635 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6638 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6640 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6641 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6643 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6644 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6645 for &"*"& on its own.
6647 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6651 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6652 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6653 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6654 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6655 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6656 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6657 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6659 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6660 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6661 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6662 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6663 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6668 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6670 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6671 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6672 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6673 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6674 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6676 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6677 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6678 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6679 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6680 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6681 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6683 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6684 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6690 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6691 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6692 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6693 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6694 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6695 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6699 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6700 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6702 [name="$local_part"]
6704 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6705 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6706 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6707 of the following form is provided:
6709 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6711 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6713 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6715 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6716 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6717 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6722 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6723 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6724 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6725 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6726 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6727 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6728 an expansion string could contain:
6730 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6732 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6733 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6734 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6735 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6737 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6738 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6739 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6740 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6741 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6743 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6745 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6746 altered and nothing is added.
6748 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6749 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6750 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6751 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6752 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6754 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6755 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6756 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6757 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6758 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6759 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6761 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6763 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6764 white space is ignored.
6766 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6767 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6768 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6769 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6770 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6772 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6773 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6775 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6776 white space is ignored.
6778 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6779 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6780 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6781 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6782 the pseudo-type MXH:
6784 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6786 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6789 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6790 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6791 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6792 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6793 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6794 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6795 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6796 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6798 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6799 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6801 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6802 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6803 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6805 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6806 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6807 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6808 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6809 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6812 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6813 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6814 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6815 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6816 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6817 result of a successful lookup such as:
6819 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6821 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6822 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6823 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6826 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6827 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6828 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6829 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6830 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6832 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6833 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6834 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6836 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6837 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6838 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6839 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6841 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6842 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6843 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6845 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6846 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6847 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6848 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6849 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6850 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6851 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6852 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6853 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6854 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6856 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6857 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6859 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6860 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6865 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6866 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6867 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6868 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6869 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6870 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6871 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6872 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6873 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6874 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6875 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6876 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6878 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6879 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6880 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6881 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6882 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6884 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6885 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6887 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6888 the way they handle the results of a query:
6891 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6894 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6895 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6897 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6898 from all of them are returned.
6902 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6903 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6904 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6905 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6908 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6909 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6910 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6911 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6913 data = ${lookup ldap \
6914 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6915 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6917 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6918 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6919 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6920 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6922 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
6923 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
6924 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
6927 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6928 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6929 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6930 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6931 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6932 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6934 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6935 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6943 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6944 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6948 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6950 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6954 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6956 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6958 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6960 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6961 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6962 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6966 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6967 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6968 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6970 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6974 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6976 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6978 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6980 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6981 authentication below.
6984 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6985 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6986 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6987 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6988 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6991 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6993 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6994 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6995 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6996 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6997 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6998 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6999 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7000 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7001 failures, and timeouts.
7003 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7004 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7005 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7006 doubled. For example
7008 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7010 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7011 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7012 the local host) is used.
7014 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7015 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7016 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7017 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7020 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7021 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7022 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7023 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7025 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7027 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7028 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7030 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7032 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7033 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7034 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7035 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7036 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7037 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7038 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7041 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7042 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7043 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7046 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7049 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7053 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7054 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7058 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7059 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7060 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7061 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7062 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7063 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7064 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7065 them. The following names are recognized:
7067 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7068 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7069 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7070 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7071 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7072 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7073 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7075 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7076 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7077 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7078 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7080 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7081 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7082 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7083 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7084 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7085 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7086 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7087 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7088 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7090 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7091 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7094 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7095 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7098 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7099 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7102 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7103 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7104 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7105 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7107 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7108 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7109 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7111 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7112 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7113 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7114 quoting has two advantages:
7117 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7118 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7120 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7123 For example, a setting such as
7125 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7127 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7129 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7130 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7131 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7132 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7136 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7137 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7142 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7143 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7144 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7145 as a sequence of values, for example
7147 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7149 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7150 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7151 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7152 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7153 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7156 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7157 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7158 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7160 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7161 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7162 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7163 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7164 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7165 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7166 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7168 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7169 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7170 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7172 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7175 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7178 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7179 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7181 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7182 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7184 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7185 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7186 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7187 results of LDAP lookups.
7192 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7193 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7194 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7195 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7196 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7197 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7198 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7199 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7201 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7203 might return the string
7205 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7206 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7208 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7210 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7216 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7217 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7218 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7222 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7223 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7224 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7225 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7226 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7227 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7228 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7229 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7230 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7231 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7232 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7233 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7236 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7239 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7240 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7242 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7247 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7249 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7250 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7251 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7255 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7256 with a newline between the data for each row.
7259 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7260 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7261 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7262 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7263 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7264 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7265 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7266 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7267 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7268 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7269 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7270 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7272 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7273 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7274 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7275 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7276 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7277 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7279 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7281 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7282 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7283 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7285 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7286 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7288 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7289 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7290 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7291 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7292 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7293 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7295 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7296 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7297 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7298 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7299 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7300 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7301 characters are not special.
7303 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7304 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7305 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7306 done by starting the query with
7308 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7310 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7312 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7313 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7314 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7317 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7319 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7320 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7321 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7323 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7324 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7325 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7328 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7332 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7334 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7336 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7337 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7338 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7340 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7344 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7345 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7346 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7347 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7348 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7350 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7351 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7353 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7354 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7356 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7359 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7360 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7362 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7363 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7364 is zero because no rows are affected.
7367 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7368 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7369 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7370 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7371 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7374 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7376 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7377 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7378 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7380 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7381 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7384 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7385 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7386 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7387 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7388 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7389 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7390 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7391 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7392 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7394 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7395 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7397 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7399 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7400 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7402 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7403 quote, which it doubles.
7405 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7406 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7407 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7408 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7409 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7410 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7419 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7420 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7421 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7422 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7423 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7424 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7425 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7426 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7427 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7429 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7430 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7431 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7432 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7436 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7437 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7438 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7439 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7440 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7441 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7442 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7443 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7446 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7447 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7448 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7450 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7451 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7452 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7453 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7454 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7456 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7457 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7459 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7460 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7461 senders based on the receiving domain.
7466 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7467 .cindex "list" "negation"
7468 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7469 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7470 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7471 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7472 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7473 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7475 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7476 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7477 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7478 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7479 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7481 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7483 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7484 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7485 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7487 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7489 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7490 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7491 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7493 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7494 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7499 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7500 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7501 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7502 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7503 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7504 file names are not allowed,
7505 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7506 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7510 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7511 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7513 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7514 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7515 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7517 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7521 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7522 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7523 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7524 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7526 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7527 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7529 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7531 and the file contains the lines
7536 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7537 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7541 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7542 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7543 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7544 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7545 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7546 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7547 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7548 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7550 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7551 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7552 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7553 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7558 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7559 .cindex "named lists"
7560 .cindex "list" "named"
7561 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7562 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7563 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7564 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7565 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7566 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7567 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7569 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7571 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7572 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7573 configured with the line
7575 domains = +local_domains
7577 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7578 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7582 domains = ! +local_domains
7583 transport = remote_smtp
7586 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7587 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7588 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7589 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7591 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7592 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7594 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7596 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7597 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7598 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7600 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7601 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7602 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7604 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7605 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7607 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7608 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7609 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7611 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7613 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7614 referenced lists if you can.
7616 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7617 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7618 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7620 domains = +local_domains
7622 on several of your routers
7623 or in several ACL statements,
7624 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7625 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7626 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7627 the same each time they are referenced.
7629 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7630 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7631 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7632 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7636 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7637 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7638 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7639 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7640 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7643 ALIST = host1 : host2
7644 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7646 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7648 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7650 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7653 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7654 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7656 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7658 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7662 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7663 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7664 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7665 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7666 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7667 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7668 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7669 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7670 message. For example:
7672 domainlist special_domains = \
7673 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7675 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7676 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7677 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7678 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7679 same list each time.
7681 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7682 cache the result anyway. For example:
7684 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7686 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7687 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7691 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7692 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7693 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7694 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7695 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7698 .cindex "primary host name"
7699 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7700 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7701 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7702 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7703 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7704 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7705 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7706 differ only in their names.
7708 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7709 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7710 .cindex "domain literal"
7711 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7712 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7713 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7714 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7715 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7716 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7719 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7720 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7721 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7722 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7723 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7724 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7725 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7726 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7727 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7728 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7729 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7731 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7732 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7733 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7734 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7735 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7737 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7738 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7739 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7740 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7741 on a router). For example:
7743 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7745 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7746 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7748 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7749 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7750 contain negative items.
7752 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7753 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7754 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7756 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7757 an.other.domain : ...
7759 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7760 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7762 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7763 an.other.domain ? ...
7766 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7767 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7768 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7769 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7770 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7771 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7772 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7773 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7774 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7778 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7779 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7780 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7781 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7782 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7783 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7784 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7785 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7786 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7788 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7789 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7790 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7791 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7792 expression by expansion, of course).
7794 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7795 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7796 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7797 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7798 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7799 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7801 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7803 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7804 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7805 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7806 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7807 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7808 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7809 other statements in the same ACL.
7812 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7813 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7815 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7817 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7818 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7821 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7822 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7823 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7824 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7825 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7826 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7829 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7830 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7831 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7832 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7834 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7835 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7837 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7838 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7839 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7840 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7841 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7843 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7844 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7845 between the pattern and the domain.
7848 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7850 domainlist funny_domains = \
7853 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7854 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7855 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7856 nis;domains.byname : \
7857 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7859 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7860 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7861 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7862 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7863 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7868 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7869 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7870 .cindex "list" "host list"
7871 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7872 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7873 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7874 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7875 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7876 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7877 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7880 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7881 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7882 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7883 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7884 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7885 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7888 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7889 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7890 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7894 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7895 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7896 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7897 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7898 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7899 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7900 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7903 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7904 inspecting its IP address:
7907 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7908 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7909 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7910 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7911 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7912 with the IP address of the subject host.
7914 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7915 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7916 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7917 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7918 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7921 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7922 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7923 domain name, as just described.
7926 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7927 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7928 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7929 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7930 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7931 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7932 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7933 that can never match a client host.
7936 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7937 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7938 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7939 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7941 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7945 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7946 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7947 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7948 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7949 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7950 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7951 significant end of the address.
7953 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7954 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7955 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7956 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7960 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7961 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7964 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7966 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7967 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7969 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7970 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7973 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7975 could make use of a file containing
7980 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7981 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7982 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7984 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7987 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7993 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7994 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7995 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7996 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7997 address, the pattern takes this form:
7999 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8003 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8005 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8006 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8007 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8008 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8009 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8010 returned by the lookup is not used.
8012 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8013 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8014 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8015 patterns of this form:
8017 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8021 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8023 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8024 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8025 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8026 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8027 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8029 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8030 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8031 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8032 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8033 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8034 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8035 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8036 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8037 addresses are always used.
8039 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8040 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8041 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8044 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8045 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8046 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8047 case the IP address is used on its own.
8051 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8052 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8053 .cindex "unknown host name"
8054 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8055 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8056 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8057 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8058 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8061 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8062 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8063 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8064 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8065 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8066 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8067 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8069 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8070 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8072 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8073 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8074 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8075 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8076 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8077 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8078 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8079 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8080 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8082 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8083 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8085 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8086 .cindex "alias for host"
8087 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8088 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8091 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8092 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8093 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8094 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8095 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8098 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8099 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8100 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8101 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8102 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8103 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8104 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8109 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8110 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8111 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8112 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8113 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8115 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8117 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8118 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8119 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8126 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8127 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8128 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8129 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8130 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8131 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8133 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8134 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8136 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8137 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8138 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8139 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8140 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8141 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8144 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8145 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8147 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8149 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8150 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8153 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8154 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8157 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8160 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8161 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8162 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8165 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8166 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8170 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8172 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8173 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8174 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8175 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8176 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8177 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8178 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8179 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8180 host lists such as whitelists.
8184 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8185 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8186 .cindex "unknown host name"
8187 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8188 If a pattern is of the form
8190 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8194 dbm;/host/accept/list
8196 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8197 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8200 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8201 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8202 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8203 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8204 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8205 lookup, both using the same file.
8209 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8210 If a pattern is of the form
8212 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8214 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8215 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8216 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8218 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8219 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8221 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8222 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8223 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8226 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8227 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8228 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8230 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8231 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8232 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8233 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8234 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8235 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8239 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8241 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8242 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8243 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8246 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8248 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8249 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8250 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8251 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8252 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8253 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8255 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8256 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8258 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8259 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8261 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8262 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8268 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8269 .cindex "list" "address list"
8270 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8271 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8272 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8273 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8274 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8275 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8276 using this option setting:
8280 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8281 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8282 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8283 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8285 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8288 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8290 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8291 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8292 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8293 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8294 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8295 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8296 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8298 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8299 *@+hostile_domains:\
8300 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8301 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8303 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8304 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8305 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8306 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8307 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8309 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8310 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8311 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8312 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8313 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8315 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8318 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8319 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8323 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8324 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8325 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8326 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8327 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8328 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8329 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8331 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8332 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8334 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8335 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8338 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8339 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8340 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8343 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8344 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8345 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8347 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8348 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8349 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8350 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8352 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8353 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8355 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8356 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8357 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8358 default. For example, with this lookup:
8360 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8362 the file could contains lines like this:
8364 user1@domain1.example
8367 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8370 nimrod@jaeger.example
8374 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8375 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8377 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8379 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8380 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8382 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8383 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8384 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8388 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8389 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8394 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8395 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8396 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8397 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8398 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8399 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8400 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8401 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8402 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8404 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8405 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8406 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8407 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8408 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8411 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8413 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8415 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8417 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8419 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8420 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8421 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8422 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8423 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8424 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8426 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8429 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8432 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8433 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8434 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8435 might have entries like
8437 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8438 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8441 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8442 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8443 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8444 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8446 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8447 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8448 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8451 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8452 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8453 can only return a single list of local parts.
8456 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8457 in these two examples:
8460 senders = *@+my_list
8462 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8463 example it is a named domain list.
8468 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8469 .cindex "case of local parts"
8470 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8471 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8472 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8473 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8474 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8475 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8476 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8477 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8480 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8481 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8482 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8483 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8484 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8485 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8486 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8489 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8490 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8491 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8492 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8493 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8494 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8495 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8496 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8500 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8501 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8502 .cindex "local part" "list"
8503 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8504 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8505 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8506 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8507 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8508 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8509 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8510 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8512 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8513 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8514 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8515 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8516 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8517 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8518 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8520 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8528 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8529 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8530 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8531 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8533 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8534 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8535 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8536 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8537 escape character, as described in the following section.
8541 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8542 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8543 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8544 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8545 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8546 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8547 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8548 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8550 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8551 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8552 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8553 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8555 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8557 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8558 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8563 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8564 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8565 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8566 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8567 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8568 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8569 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8572 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8573 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8574 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8577 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8578 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8579 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8581 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8582 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8583 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8584 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8585 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8586 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8587 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8590 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8591 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8592 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8595 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8596 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8597 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8598 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8600 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8602 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8603 Exim message identifier. For example:
8605 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8607 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8608 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8611 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8612 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8613 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8614 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8615 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8616 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8617 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8618 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8619 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8620 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8621 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8622 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8628 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8629 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8630 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8631 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8632 white space is significant.
8635 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8636 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8637 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8642 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8643 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8644 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8645 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8646 given, the expansion fails.
8648 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8649 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8650 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8651 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8655 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8656 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8657 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8658 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8659 string easier to understand.
8661 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8662 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8663 expansion item below.
8665 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8666 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8668 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8669 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8673 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8674 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8675 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8677 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8678 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8679 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8680 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8681 must have the following type:
8683 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8685 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8686 function should return one of the following values:
8688 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8689 into the expanded string that is being built.
8691 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8692 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8694 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8695 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8697 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8699 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8700 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8701 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8703 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8704 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8705 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8706 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8707 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8708 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8709 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8712 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8715 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8716 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8717 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8718 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8719 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8720 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8721 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8722 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8723 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8725 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8726 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8727 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8730 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8731 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8733 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8734 appear, for example:
8736 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8738 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8739 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8742 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8743 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8744 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8745 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8746 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8747 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8748 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8749 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8750 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8751 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8752 <&'string3'&> as before.
8754 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8755 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8756 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8757 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8758 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8759 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8760 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8761 provided. For example:
8763 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8767 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8769 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8770 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8773 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8774 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8775 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8777 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8778 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8779 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8780 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8781 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8782 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8783 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8785 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8787 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8788 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8791 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8792 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8793 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8794 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8795 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8796 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8798 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8799 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8800 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8801 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8803 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8805 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8806 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8807 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8808 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8809 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8811 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8813 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8814 letters appear. For example:
8816 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8817 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8818 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8821 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8822 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8823 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8824 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8825 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8826 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8827 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8828 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8829 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8830 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8831 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8832 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8833 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8834 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8838 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8839 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8840 lines) may be present.
8842 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8843 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8846 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8847 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8848 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8851 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8852 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8853 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8854 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8855 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8856 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8857 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8858 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8861 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8862 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8863 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8864 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8865 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8866 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8869 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8870 command of the following form:
8872 headers charset "UTF-8"
8874 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8875 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8876 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8877 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8878 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8881 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8882 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8883 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8884 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8886 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8887 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8888 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8889 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8890 router or transport are not accessible.
8892 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8893 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8894 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8895 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8896 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8897 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8899 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8900 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8901 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8902 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8903 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8904 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8905 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8907 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8908 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8909 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8910 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8911 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8912 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8913 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8914 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8917 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8918 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8920 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8921 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8922 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8923 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8924 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8925 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8926 present. For example:
8928 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8930 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8933 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8935 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8936 an Exim configuration:
8938 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8940 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8943 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8944 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8945 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8947 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8948 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8949 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8950 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8951 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8952 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8955 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8956 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8957 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8958 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8959 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8960 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8962 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8964 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8965 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8966 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8967 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8968 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8970 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8971 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8972 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8974 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8978 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8981 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8982 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8983 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8984 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8985 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8986 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8987 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8990 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8992 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8993 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8994 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8997 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8998 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8999 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9000 described in the next item.
9002 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9003 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9004 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9005 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9006 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9007 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9008 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9009 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9010 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9012 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9013 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9014 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9015 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9016 out by the system administrator.
9019 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9020 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9021 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9022 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9023 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9024 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9025 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9026 original lookup fails.
9028 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9029 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9030 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9031 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9032 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9033 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9034 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9035 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9037 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9038 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9039 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9040 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9042 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9043 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9044 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9045 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9047 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9049 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9051 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9052 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9054 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9059 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9060 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9062 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9063 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9064 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9065 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9066 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9067 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9069 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9071 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9072 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9073 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9075 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9076 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9077 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9078 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9079 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9080 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9081 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9083 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9085 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9086 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9087 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9088 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9091 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9093 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9097 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9098 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9099 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9100 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9101 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9102 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9103 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9104 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9106 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9107 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9108 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9109 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9110 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9113 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9114 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9115 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9117 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9118 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9121 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9122 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9123 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9124 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9125 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9126 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9127 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9128 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9130 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9131 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9132 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9133 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9134 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9135 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9136 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9137 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9138 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9139 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9141 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9142 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9143 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9144 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9146 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9147 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9148 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9149 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9150 is the expansion of the third argument.
9152 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9153 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9154 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9156 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9157 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9158 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9159 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9160 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9161 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9162 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9163 newlines are left in the string.
9164 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9165 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9166 the string expansion fails.
9168 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9169 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9173 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9174 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9175 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9176 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9177 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9178 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9179 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9182 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9183 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9185 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9186 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9187 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9188 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9189 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9192 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9194 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9195 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9196 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9197 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9198 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9199 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9201 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9203 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9204 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9205 turns them into spaces:
9207 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9209 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9210 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9211 addition, the following errors can occur:
9214 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9216 Failure to connect the socket;
9218 Failure to write the request string;
9220 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9223 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9224 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9225 errors occurs. For example:
9227 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9230 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9231 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9232 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9233 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9234 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9236 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9237 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9240 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9241 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9242 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9245 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9246 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9247 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9248 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9249 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9250 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9251 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9252 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9253 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9255 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9257 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9260 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9262 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9263 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9266 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9267 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9268 expansion item above.
9270 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9271 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9272 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9273 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9274 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9275 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9276 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9277 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9279 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9280 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9281 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9283 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9284 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9285 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9286 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9287 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9290 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9291 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9292 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9293 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9296 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9297 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9299 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9300 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9304 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9305 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9308 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9309 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9310 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9311 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9313 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9314 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9317 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9318 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9319 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9320 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9321 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9322 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9323 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9324 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9326 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9328 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9329 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9330 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9332 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9334 yields &"defabc"&, and
9336 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9338 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9339 the regular expression from string expansion.
9343 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9344 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9345 .cindex "substring extraction"
9346 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9347 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9348 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9349 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9350 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9352 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9354 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9355 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9358 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9359 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9360 length required. For example
9362 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9364 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9365 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9366 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9367 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9369 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9370 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9371 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9373 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9375 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9376 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9377 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9379 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9381 yields an empty string, but
9383 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9387 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9388 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9389 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9390 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9393 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9395 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9399 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9400 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9401 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9402 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9403 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9404 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9405 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9406 replacement list. For example
9408 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9410 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9411 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9412 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9418 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9419 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9420 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9421 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9422 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9423 following operations can be performed:
9426 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9427 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9428 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9429 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9430 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9431 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9434 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9435 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9436 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9437 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9438 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9439 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9440 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9441 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9442 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9444 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9445 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9446 character. For example:
9448 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9450 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9451 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9452 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9456 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9457 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9458 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9459 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9460 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9461 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9462 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9463 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9464 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9466 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9467 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9468 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9469 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9470 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9471 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9474 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9475 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9476 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9477 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9478 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9481 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9482 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9483 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9484 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9485 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9486 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9487 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9490 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9491 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9492 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9493 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9494 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9495 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9496 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9497 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9498 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9499 C programming language):
9501 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9502 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9503 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9504 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9507 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9509 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9510 space is permitted before or after operators.
9512 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9513 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9514 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9515 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9516 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9518 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9519 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9520 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9523 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9524 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9525 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9526 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9527 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9528 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9529 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9530 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9531 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9532 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9533 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9536 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9538 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9541 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9544 {$recipients_count} \
9545 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9549 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9550 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9553 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9554 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9555 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9558 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9560 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9561 and then re-expands what it has found.
9564 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9566 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9567 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9568 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9569 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9570 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9571 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9572 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9573 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9574 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9576 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9577 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9578 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9579 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9580 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9581 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9582 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9585 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9586 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9587 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9588 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9589 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9590 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9592 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9594 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9595 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9599 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9600 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9601 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9602 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9603 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9604 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9607 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9608 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9609 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9610 .cindex "lower casing"
9611 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9612 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9613 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9618 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9619 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9620 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9621 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9622 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9623 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9625 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9627 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9628 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9629 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9632 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9633 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9634 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9635 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9636 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9640 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9641 .cindex "masked IP address"
9642 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9643 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9644 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9645 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9646 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9647 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9648 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9649 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9650 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9652 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9654 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9655 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9656 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9657 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9659 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9663 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9665 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9668 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9670 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9671 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9672 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9673 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9676 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9677 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9678 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9679 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9680 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9681 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9683 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9685 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9688 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9689 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9690 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9691 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9692 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9693 is an empty string or
9694 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9695 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9696 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9697 respectively For example,
9705 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9706 variable or a message header.
9708 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9709 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9710 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9711 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9712 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9713 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9714 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9717 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9718 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9719 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9720 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9721 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9723 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9729 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9730 yields an unchanged string.
9733 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9734 .cindex "random number"
9735 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9736 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9737 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9738 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9739 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9740 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9744 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9745 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9746 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9747 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9748 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9749 for DNS. For example,
9751 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9755 4.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9759 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9760 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9761 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9762 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9763 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9764 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9765 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9766 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9767 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9770 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9772 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9773 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9777 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9778 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9779 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9780 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9781 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9782 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9783 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9784 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9786 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9787 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9788 to use this operator as well.
9792 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9793 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9794 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9795 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9796 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9797 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9798 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9801 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9802 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9803 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9804 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9805 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9806 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9809 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9810 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9811 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9812 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9813 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9814 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9815 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9816 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9817 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9818 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9819 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9820 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9821 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9823 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9824 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9825 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9827 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9828 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9829 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9830 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9831 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9835 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9836 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9837 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9838 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9839 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9840 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9843 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9844 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9845 .cindex "substring extraction"
9846 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9847 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9848 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9849 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9851 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9853 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9854 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9856 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9857 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9858 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9859 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9862 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9863 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9864 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9865 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9866 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9867 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9870 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9871 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9872 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9873 .cindex "upper casing"
9874 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9875 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9876 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9884 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9885 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9886 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9887 while expanding strings:
9890 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9891 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9892 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9893 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9896 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9897 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9899 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9905 &`>= `& greater or equal
9907 &`<= `& less or equal
9911 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9913 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9914 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9915 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9916 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9917 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9921 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9922 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9923 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9924 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9925 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9926 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9928 An empty string is treated as false.
9929 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
9930 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
9931 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9933 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9934 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9937 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9941 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9942 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9943 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9944 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9945 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9946 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9947 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9948 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9950 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9952 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9953 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9954 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9955 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9956 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9957 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9958 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9959 included in the binary.
9961 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9962 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9963 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9964 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9965 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9966 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9967 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9968 string in LDAP form is:
9970 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9972 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9973 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9975 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9977 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9982 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9983 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9984 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9985 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9986 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9987 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9991 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9992 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9993 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9994 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9995 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9996 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9999 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10000 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10001 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10002 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10003 whatever its length.
10006 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10007 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10008 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10009 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10011 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10012 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10013 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10014 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10015 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10016 support &[crypt16()]&.
10018 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10019 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10020 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10021 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10022 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10024 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10025 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10026 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10028 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10029 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10030 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10031 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10032 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10034 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10035 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10036 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10037 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10038 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10039 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10041 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10043 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10044 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10046 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10047 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10048 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10049 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10050 exists in the message. For example,
10052 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10054 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10055 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10057 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10058 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10059 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10060 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10061 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10062 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10063 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10064 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10065 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10067 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10068 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10069 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10070 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10071 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10072 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10073 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10074 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10076 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10077 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10078 .cindex "first delivery"
10079 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10080 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10081 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10082 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10085 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10086 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10087 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10088 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10089 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10091 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10092 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10093 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10094 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10095 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10097 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10098 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10099 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10101 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10102 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10103 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10105 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10106 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10107 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10108 list separator is changed to a comma:
10110 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10112 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10113 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10116 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10117 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10118 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10119 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10120 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10121 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10122 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10123 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10124 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10127 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10128 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10129 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10130 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10131 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10132 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10133 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10134 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10135 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10139 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10140 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10141 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10142 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10143 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10144 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10147 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10148 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10150 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10151 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10152 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10153 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10157 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10158 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10159 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10160 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10161 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10162 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10163 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10164 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10165 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10166 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10167 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10169 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10170 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10171 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10172 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10173 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10175 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10176 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10177 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10178 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10180 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10182 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10184 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10185 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10186 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10187 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10188 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10189 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10190 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10191 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10192 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10193 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10194 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10195 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10196 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10200 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10201 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10202 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10203 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10204 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10205 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10206 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10207 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10208 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10211 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10212 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10213 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10214 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10215 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10216 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10217 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10218 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10219 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10223 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10224 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10225 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10226 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10227 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10228 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10229 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10230 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10231 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10232 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10233 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10236 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10238 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10239 backslashes is also required.
10241 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10242 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10243 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10244 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10245 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10246 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10248 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10249 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10250 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10251 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10252 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10253 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10254 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10255 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10257 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10258 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10259 See &*match_local_part*&.
10261 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10262 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10263 See &*match_local_part*&.
10265 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10266 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10268 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10269 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10270 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10271 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10274 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10276 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10279 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10281 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10283 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10284 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10285 in a single test such as
10286 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10287 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10288 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10289 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10291 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10293 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10295 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10297 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10298 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10299 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10300 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10301 masks. For example:
10303 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10305 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10306 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10307 address mask, for example:
10309 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10311 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10312 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10314 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10319 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10320 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10323 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10325 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10327 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10328 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10329 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10330 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10331 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10332 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10335 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10337 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10338 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10339 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10340 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10342 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10344 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10345 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10346 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10347 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10351 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10352 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10355 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10356 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10357 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10358 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10360 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10361 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10362 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10363 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10364 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10365 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10366 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10367 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10368 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10369 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10370 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10374 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10375 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10377 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10378 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10379 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10380 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10381 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10382 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10383 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10385 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10386 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10387 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10388 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10389 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10391 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10393 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10395 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10397 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10398 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10399 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10400 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10401 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10402 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10403 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10404 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10407 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10411 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10412 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10413 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10414 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10415 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10417 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10418 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10419 building Exim. For example:
10421 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10423 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10424 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10425 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10426 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10428 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10429 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10430 configuration, you might have this:
10432 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10434 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10436 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10438 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10439 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10440 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10441 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10442 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10443 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10446 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10448 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10449 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10450 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10451 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10452 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10455 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10456 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10457 this library, you need to set
10459 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10461 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10462 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10464 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10466 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10467 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10468 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10470 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10471 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10472 the authentication is successful. For example:
10474 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10478 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10479 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10480 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10482 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10483 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10484 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10485 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10486 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10487 by a process that is not running as root.
10489 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10490 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10491 building Exim. For example:
10493 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10495 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10496 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10497 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10499 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10500 two are mandatory. For example:
10502 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10504 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10505 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10506 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10511 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10512 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10513 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10514 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10515 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10516 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10517 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10521 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10522 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10523 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10524 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10525 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10528 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10530 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10531 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10532 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10534 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10535 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10537 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10538 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10539 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10540 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10541 parsed but not evaluated.
10543 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10548 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10549 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10550 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10551 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10552 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10555 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10556 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10557 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10558 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10559 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10560 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10561 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10562 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10563 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10564 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10565 matching condition.
10567 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10568 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10569 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10570 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10571 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10572 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10573 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10574 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10575 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10576 during subsequent delivery.
10578 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10579 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10580 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10581 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10582 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10583 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10584 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10585 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10588 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10589 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10590 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10591 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10592 be preserved by coding like this:
10594 warn !verify = sender
10595 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10597 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10598 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10601 .vitem &$address_data$&
10602 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10603 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10604 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10605 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10606 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10607 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10610 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10611 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10612 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10613 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10614 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10615 from the child's routing.
10617 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10618 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10619 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10622 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10623 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10624 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10626 .vitem &$address_file$&
10627 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10628 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10629 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10630 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10631 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10633 /home/r2d2/savemail
10635 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10636 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10637 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10638 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10639 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10640 to the relevant file.
10642 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10643 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10644 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10645 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10647 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10648 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10649 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10650 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10652 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10653 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10654 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10655 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10656 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10657 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10658 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10659 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10660 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10661 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10662 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10663 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10664 command line option.
10669 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10670 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10671 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10672 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10673 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10674 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10675 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10676 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10677 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10678 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10679 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10681 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10682 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10683 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10684 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10685 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10688 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10689 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10690 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10691 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10692 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10693 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10694 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10695 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10696 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10697 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10698 an undefined mechanism.
10701 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10702 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10703 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10704 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10705 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10706 the ACL malware condition.
10709 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10710 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10711 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10712 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10713 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10714 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10716 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10717 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10718 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10719 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10720 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10721 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10722 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10724 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10725 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10726 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10727 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10728 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10730 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10731 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10732 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10733 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10734 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10736 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10737 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10738 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10739 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10740 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10741 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10742 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10744 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10745 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10746 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10747 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10748 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10749 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10750 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10752 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10753 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10754 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10756 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10757 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10758 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10759 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10760 compilations of the same version of the program.
10762 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10763 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10764 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10765 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10766 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10768 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10769 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10770 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10771 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10772 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10774 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10775 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10776 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10778 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10779 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10780 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10781 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10782 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10783 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10784 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10785 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10786 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10789 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10790 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10791 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10792 case for &$domain$&.
10794 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10795 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10796 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10797 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10799 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10800 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10801 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10802 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10803 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10804 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10806 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10807 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10808 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10810 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10813 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10814 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10815 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10816 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10817 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10818 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10819 the &(smtp)& transport.
10822 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10823 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10824 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10825 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10828 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10829 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10830 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10831 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10832 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10833 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10836 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10837 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10838 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10839 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10843 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10844 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10845 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10846 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10847 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10848 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10849 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10852 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10853 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10854 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10857 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10858 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10859 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10861 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10862 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10863 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10865 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10866 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10867 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10869 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10870 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10871 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10872 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10873 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10875 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10876 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10877 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10878 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10879 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10883 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10884 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10885 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10886 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10887 by a setting on the transport itself.
10889 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10890 of the environment variable HOME.
10894 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10895 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10896 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10897 to local and remote transports.
10899 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10900 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10901 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10902 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10903 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10904 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10905 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10908 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10909 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10910 client is connected.
10913 .vitem &$host_address$&
10914 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10915 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10916 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10917 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10919 .vitem &$host_data$&
10920 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10921 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10922 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10923 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10925 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10926 message = $host_data
10928 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10929 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10930 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10931 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10932 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10933 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10934 variables is set to &"1"&.
10937 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10938 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10941 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10942 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10943 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10946 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10947 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10948 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10949 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10950 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10951 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10952 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10953 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10954 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10955 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10957 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10958 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10959 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10963 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10964 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10965 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10966 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10967 a unique name for the file.
10969 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10970 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10971 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10973 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10974 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10975 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10979 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10980 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10981 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10985 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10986 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10987 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10990 .vitem &$load_average$&
10991 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10992 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10993 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10994 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10996 .vitem &$local_part$&
10997 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10998 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10999 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11000 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11001 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11003 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11004 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11005 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11006 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11009 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11010 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11011 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11012 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11013 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11014 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11016 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11017 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11018 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11021 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11022 local part of the recipient address.
11024 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11025 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11026 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11028 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11031 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11032 abc\:xyz@test.example
11034 the value of &$local_part$& is
11038 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11039 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11042 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11044 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11045 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11046 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11048 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11049 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11050 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11051 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11052 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11053 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11054 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11056 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11057 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11058 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11059 variable expands to nothing.
11061 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11062 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11063 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11064 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11065 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11067 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11068 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11069 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11070 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11071 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11073 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11074 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11075 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11076 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11078 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11079 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11080 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11082 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11083 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11084 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11085 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11086 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11087 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11088 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11089 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11091 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11092 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11093 This contains the expanded value of the
11094 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11097 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11098 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11099 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11100 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11101 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11102 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11104 .vitem &$log_space$&
11105 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11106 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11107 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11108 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11109 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11110 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11113 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11114 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11115 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11116 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11117 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11118 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11119 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11122 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11123 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11124 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11125 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11126 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11128 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11129 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11130 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11131 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11132 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11133 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11136 .vitem &$message_age$&
11137 .cindex "message" "age of"
11138 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11139 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11140 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11143 .vitem &$message_body$&
11144 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11145 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11146 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11147 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11148 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11149 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11150 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11151 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11152 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11154 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11155 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11156 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11157 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11158 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11160 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11161 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11162 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11163 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11164 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11165 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11168 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11169 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11170 .cindex "message body" "size"
11171 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11172 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11173 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11174 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11175 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11177 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11178 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11179 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11180 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11181 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11182 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11183 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11184 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11186 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11187 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11188 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11189 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11190 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11191 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11193 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11194 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11195 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11196 contents of header lines is done.
11198 .vitem &$message_id$&
11199 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11201 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11202 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11203 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11204 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11205 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11206 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11207 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11208 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11209 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11210 from the body is not counted.
11212 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11213 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11214 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11215 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11216 header and the body).
11218 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11220 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11222 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11224 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11225 message has not yet been received.
11227 .vitem &$message_size$&
11228 .cindex "size" "of message"
11229 .cindex "message" "size"
11230 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11231 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11232 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11233 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11234 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11235 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11236 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11237 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11238 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11240 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11241 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11242 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11243 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11245 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11246 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11247 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11248 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11250 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11251 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11252 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11254 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11255 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11256 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11257 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11258 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11259 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11260 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11261 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11262 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11263 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11265 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11266 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11267 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11269 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11270 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11271 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11272 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11273 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11274 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11275 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11276 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11277 the original address.
11279 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11280 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11281 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11282 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11283 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11285 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11286 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11287 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11289 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11290 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11291 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11292 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11293 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11294 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11295 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11296 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11297 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11299 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11300 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11301 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11302 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11303 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11304 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11305 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11306 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11309 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11310 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11311 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11312 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11314 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11315 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11316 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11317 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11322 This variable contains the current process id.
11324 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11325 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11326 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11327 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11328 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11329 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11330 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11331 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11332 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11333 variable"& error if encountered.
11335 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11336 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11337 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11338 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11339 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11340 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11341 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11344 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11345 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11346 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11347 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11349 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11350 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11351 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11352 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11354 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11355 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11356 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11357 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11359 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11360 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11361 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11363 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11364 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11365 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11366 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11368 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11369 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11370 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11371 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11372 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11374 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11375 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11376 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11377 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11378 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11379 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11381 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11382 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11383 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11384 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11385 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11387 .vitem &$received_count$&
11388 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11389 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11390 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11391 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11394 .vitem &$received_for$&
11395 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11396 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11397 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11398 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11399 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11401 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11402 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11403 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11404 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11405 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11406 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11407 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11410 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11411 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11412 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11413 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11414 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11417 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11418 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11419 &(smtp)& transport).
11421 .vitem &$received_port$&
11422 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11423 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11425 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11426 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11427 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11428 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11429 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11430 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11431 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11432 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11433 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11435 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11436 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11437 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11438 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11439 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11440 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11442 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11443 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11444 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11446 .vitem &$received_time$&
11447 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11448 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11449 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11451 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11452 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11453 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11454 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11455 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11457 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11458 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11460 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11461 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11462 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11463 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11465 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11466 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11467 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11468 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11471 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11472 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11475 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11478 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11479 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11483 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11486 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11489 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11490 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11492 .vitem &$recipients$&
11493 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11494 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11495 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11496 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11497 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11501 In a system filter file.
11503 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11504 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11505 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11506 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11508 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11512 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11513 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11514 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11515 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11516 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11517 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11520 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11521 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11522 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11523 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11526 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11527 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11528 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11529 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11530 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11531 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11532 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11534 .vitem &$return_path$&
11535 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11536 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11537 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11538 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11539 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11540 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11541 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11542 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11543 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11544 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11547 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11548 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11549 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11552 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11553 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11554 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11555 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11556 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11557 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11558 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11561 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11562 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11563 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11564 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11565 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11566 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11567 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11568 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11570 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11571 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11572 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11573 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11574 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11575 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11577 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11578 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11579 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11580 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11581 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11582 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11583 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11584 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11586 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11587 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11588 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11590 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11591 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11592 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11594 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11595 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11596 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11597 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11598 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11601 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11602 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11604 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11605 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11606 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11607 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11609 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11610 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11611 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11612 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11613 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11614 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11615 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11616 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11617 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11618 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11619 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11620 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11621 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11623 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11624 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11625 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11626 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11627 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11628 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11630 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11631 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11632 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11633 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11635 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11636 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11637 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11638 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11639 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11640 &$authenticated_id$&.
11642 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11643 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11644 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11645 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11646 other means, this variable is empty.
11648 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11649 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11650 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11651 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11652 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11653 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11654 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11656 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11657 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11658 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11659 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11661 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11662 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11663 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11666 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11667 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11668 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11669 following are true:
11672 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11674 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11675 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11676 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11678 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11679 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11680 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11682 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11683 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11684 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11686 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11687 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11688 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11689 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11691 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11693 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11694 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11698 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11699 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11700 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11701 number that was used on the remote host.
11703 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11704 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11705 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11706 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11707 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11710 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11711 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11712 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11713 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11715 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11716 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11717 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11718 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11719 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11720 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11721 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11722 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11723 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11724 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11725 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11728 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11729 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11730 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11731 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11732 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11734 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11735 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11736 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11737 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11738 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11740 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11741 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11742 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11743 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11744 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11745 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11746 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11748 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11749 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11750 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11751 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11752 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11754 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11755 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11756 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11757 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11758 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11759 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11761 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11762 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11763 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11764 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11765 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11770 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11771 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11772 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11773 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11775 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11776 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11777 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11778 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11779 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11780 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11781 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11783 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11784 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11785 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11786 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11787 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11788 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11789 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11790 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11791 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11792 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11793 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11795 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11796 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11797 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11798 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11799 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11800 message is junk mail.
11802 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11803 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11804 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11805 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11808 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11809 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11810 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11812 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11813 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11814 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11815 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11816 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11817 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11819 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11820 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11821 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11822 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11823 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11824 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11825 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11826 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11828 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11830 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11833 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11834 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11835 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11836 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11837 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11838 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11841 .vitem &$tls_bits$&
11842 .vindex "&$tls_bits$&"
11843 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength; the meaning of
11844 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11845 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11846 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11847 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11850 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11851 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11852 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11853 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11855 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11856 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11857 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11858 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11859 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11860 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11861 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11862 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11864 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11865 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11866 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11867 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11868 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11869 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11871 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11872 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11873 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11874 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11875 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11876 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11877 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11880 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11881 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11882 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11883 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11885 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11886 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11887 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11889 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11890 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11891 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11892 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11893 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11894 values for those that are behind (west).
11897 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11898 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11899 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11901 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11902 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11903 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11904 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11907 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11908 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11909 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11912 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11913 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11914 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11915 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11918 .vindex "&$value$&"
11919 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11920 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11921 &*reduce*& expansion.
11923 .vitem &$version_number$&
11924 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11925 The version number of Exim.
11927 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11928 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11929 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11930 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11932 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11933 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11934 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11935 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11944 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11945 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11946 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11947 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11948 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11949 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11954 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11957 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11958 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11959 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11960 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11961 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11962 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11963 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11964 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11965 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11967 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11968 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11969 should usually be something like
11971 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11973 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11974 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11975 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11976 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11977 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11978 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11979 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11980 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11984 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11985 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11986 a startup when Exim is entered.
11988 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11989 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11992 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11993 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11996 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11997 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11998 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11999 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12003 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12004 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12006 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12007 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12008 with an error message of the form
12010 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12012 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12013 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12014 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12015 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12016 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12017 that was passed to &%die%&.
12020 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12021 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12022 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12025 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12027 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12028 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12029 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12031 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12032 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12033 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12034 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12036 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12037 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12038 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12039 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12040 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12041 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12042 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12045 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12046 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12047 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12048 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12049 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12050 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12051 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12052 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12053 avoided, but the output is lost.
12055 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12056 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12057 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12058 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12059 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12060 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12061 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12063 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12065 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12066 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12067 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12068 as the first subroutine argument.
12072 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12075 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12076 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12077 "Starting the daemon"
12078 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12079 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12080 .cindex "network interface"
12081 .cindex "interface" "network"
12082 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12083 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12084 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12085 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12086 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12087 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12088 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12089 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12090 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12091 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12092 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12095 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12096 and ports to listen on.
12098 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12099 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12100 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12101 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12102 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12103 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12104 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12105 as an error situation.
12107 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12108 for the outgoing connection.
12112 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12113 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12114 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12115 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12116 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12118 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12119 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12120 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12121 chapter describes how they operate.
12123 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12124 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12128 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12129 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12130 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12134 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12135 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12137 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12138 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12141 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12142 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12143 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12144 colons. For example:
12146 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12149 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12151 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12152 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12155 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12156 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12158 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12159 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12162 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12163 with a colon separator, for example:
12165 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12166 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12170 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12171 default setting contains just one port:
12173 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12175 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12176 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12177 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12178 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12179 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12183 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12184 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12185 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12186 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12187 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12188 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12190 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12192 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12194 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12196 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12200 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12201 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12202 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12203 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12204 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12205 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12208 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12209 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12210 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12211 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12212 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12213 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12217 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12220 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12222 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12223 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12224 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12228 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12229 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12230 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12231 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12232 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12233 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12234 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12235 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12236 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12237 common use of this option is expected to be
12239 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12241 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12242 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12243 this way when a daemon is started.
12245 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12246 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12247 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12248 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12249 connections via the daemon.)
12254 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12255 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12256 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12257 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12258 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12259 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12260 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12261 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12263 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12265 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12266 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12267 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12268 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12269 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12270 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12272 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12274 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12275 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12276 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12277 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12278 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12280 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12281 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12282 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12283 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12284 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12285 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12286 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12287 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12288 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12289 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12290 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12291 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12293 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12294 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12295 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12296 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12297 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12301 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12302 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12304 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12305 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12307 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12308 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12309 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12310 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12312 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12314 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12316 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12318 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12319 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12321 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12322 IPv4 loopback address only:
12324 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12326 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12328 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12330 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12334 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12335 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12336 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12337 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12340 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12341 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12342 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12343 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12345 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12346 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12347 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12348 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12349 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12350 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12351 used for listening. Consider this example:
12353 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12355 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12357 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12359 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12360 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12363 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12364 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12365 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12366 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12367 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12368 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12369 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12370 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12374 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12375 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12376 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12377 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12378 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12379 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12388 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12389 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12390 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12391 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12394 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12395 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12397 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12398 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12399 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12401 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12402 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12403 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12404 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12408 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12409 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12410 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12411 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12412 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12413 listed in more than one group.
12415 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12417 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12418 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12419 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12420 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12421 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12422 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12423 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12424 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12425 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12429 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12431 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12432 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12433 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12434 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12435 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12436 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12441 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12443 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12444 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12445 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12446 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12447 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12448 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12449 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12450 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12451 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12452 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12453 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12458 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12460 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12461 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12462 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12463 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12464 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12465 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12466 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12467 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12468 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12469 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12470 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12471 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12476 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12478 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12479 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12480 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12481 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12486 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12488 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12489 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12490 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12491 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12492 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12493 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12494 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12495 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12496 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12497 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12498 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12499 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12500 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12501 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12502 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12507 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12509 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12510 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12515 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12517 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12518 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12523 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12525 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12526 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12527 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12528 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12529 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12530 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12531 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12536 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12538 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12539 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12540 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12541 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12542 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12543 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12544 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12545 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12546 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12547 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12548 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12549 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12550 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12551 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12552 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12553 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12555 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12556 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12557 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12558 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12559 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12564 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12566 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12567 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12568 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12569 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12570 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12571 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12572 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12573 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12574 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12575 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12576 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12577 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12578 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12579 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12580 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12581 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12582 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12583 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12584 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12585 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12587 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12588 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12589 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12590 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12591 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12592 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12593 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12594 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12595 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12596 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12597 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12598 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12599 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12600 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12601 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12602 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12603 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12604 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12609 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12611 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12613 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12615 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12616 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12617 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12622 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12624 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12625 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12626 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12627 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12628 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12629 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12630 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12631 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12632 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12633 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12634 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12635 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12636 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12637 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12638 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12639 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12644 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12646 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12647 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12648 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12649 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12650 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12651 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12652 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12653 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12658 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12660 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12661 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12662 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12663 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12664 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12665 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12666 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12667 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12673 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12675 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12682 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12683 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12686 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12687 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12688 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12689 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12690 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12691 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12692 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12693 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12694 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12695 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12696 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12697 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12698 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12699 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12701 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12702 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12703 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12704 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12705 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12706 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12707 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12708 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12709 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12710 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12711 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12712 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12713 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12714 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12715 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12716 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12721 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12723 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12724 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12725 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12726 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12727 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12728 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12733 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12735 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12736 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12737 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12738 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12740 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12741 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12742 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12743 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12744 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12745 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12746 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12747 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12748 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12749 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12754 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12756 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12757 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12759 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12760 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12761 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12762 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12763 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12768 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12770 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12771 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12772 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12773 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12774 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12775 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12776 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12777 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12778 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12779 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12780 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12781 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12782 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12783 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12784 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12785 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12786 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12787 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12788 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12789 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12790 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12791 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12796 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12798 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12799 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12800 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12801 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12802 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12803 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12804 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12805 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12806 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12807 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12808 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12809 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12810 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12811 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12816 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12817 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12820 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12822 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12823 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12824 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12825 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12826 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12827 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12829 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12830 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12831 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12832 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12833 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12836 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12837 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12838 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12841 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12842 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12843 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12844 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12845 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12847 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12848 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12849 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12850 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12851 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12853 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12854 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12855 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12856 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12858 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12859 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12860 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12861 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12862 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12864 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12865 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12866 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12867 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12869 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12870 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12871 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12872 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12874 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12875 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12876 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12877 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12878 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12881 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12882 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12883 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12884 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12886 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12887 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12888 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12889 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12890 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12892 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12893 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12894 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12895 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12896 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12898 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12899 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12900 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12903 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12904 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12905 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12906 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12908 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12909 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12910 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12911 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12913 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12914 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12915 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12916 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12918 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12919 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12920 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12921 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12923 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12924 .cindex "admin user"
12925 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12926 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12927 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12928 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12929 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12930 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12931 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12933 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12934 .cindex "domain literal"
12935 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12936 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12937 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12938 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12940 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12941 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12942 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12943 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12944 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12945 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12946 the local host's IP addresses.
12949 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12950 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12951 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12952 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12953 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12954 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12955 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12956 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12957 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12959 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12960 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12961 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12962 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12963 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12964 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12965 experiment if they wish.
12967 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12968 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12969 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12970 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12971 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12972 suitable setting is:
12974 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12975 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12977 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12979 dns_check_names_pattern =
12981 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12984 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12985 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12986 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12987 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12988 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12989 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12990 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12991 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12992 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12993 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12994 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12996 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12997 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12998 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12999 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13000 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13001 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13003 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13004 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13005 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13006 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13008 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13010 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13011 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13012 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13013 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13016 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13017 .cindex "thawing messages"
13018 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13019 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13020 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13021 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13022 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13023 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13025 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13026 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13027 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13030 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13031 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13032 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13034 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13036 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13037 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13040 .option bi_command main string unset
13042 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13043 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13044 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13045 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13048 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13049 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13050 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13051 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13052 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13053 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13056 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13057 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13058 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13059 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13061 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13062 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13063 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13064 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13065 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13066 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13067 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13068 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13069 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13070 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13072 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13073 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13074 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13075 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13078 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13079 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13080 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13081 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13082 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13083 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13084 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13085 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13086 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13088 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13089 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13090 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13091 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13092 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13095 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13096 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13097 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13098 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13099 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13100 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13101 connection. A typical setting might be:
13103 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13105 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13107 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13109 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13112 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13113 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13114 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13115 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13116 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13117 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13120 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13121 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13122 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13123 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13126 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13127 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13128 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13129 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13132 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13133 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13134 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13135 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13138 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13139 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13140 callout verification. The default value is
13142 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13144 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13147 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13148 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13151 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13152 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13154 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13155 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13156 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13157 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13158 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13159 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13160 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13161 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13162 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13163 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13166 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13167 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13170 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13171 .cindex "checking disk space"
13172 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13173 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13174 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13175 message is accepted.
13177 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13178 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13179 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13180 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13181 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13182 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13183 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13184 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13187 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13188 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13190 check_spool_space = 10M
13191 check_spool_inodes = 100
13193 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13194 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13197 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13198 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13199 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13201 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13202 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13203 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13204 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13205 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13206 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13208 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13209 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13211 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13212 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13213 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13215 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13216 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13217 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13218 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13219 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13220 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13222 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13223 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13224 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13225 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13226 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13227 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13228 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13230 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13231 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13233 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13234 .cindex "warning of delay"
13235 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13236 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13237 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13238 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13239 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13240 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13241 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13244 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13246 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13247 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13248 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13249 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13253 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13254 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13256 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13259 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13260 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13261 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13262 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13263 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13264 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13265 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13266 not sent. The default is:
13268 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13269 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13270 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13271 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13274 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13275 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13276 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13277 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13279 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13280 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13281 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13282 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13283 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13284 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13285 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13286 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13288 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13289 .cindex "load average"
13290 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13291 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13292 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13293 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13294 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13297 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13298 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13299 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13300 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13301 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13302 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13303 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13304 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13306 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13307 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13308 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13309 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13310 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13311 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13312 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13313 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13315 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13316 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13317 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13318 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13321 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13322 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13323 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13324 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13325 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13326 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13327 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13330 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13331 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13332 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13333 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13334 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13335 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13336 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13337 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13338 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13339 by a setting such as this:
13341 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13343 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13344 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13345 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13346 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13347 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13348 options are applied after this global option.
13350 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13351 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13352 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13353 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13354 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13355 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13356 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13357 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13358 value of this option. The default pattern is
13360 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13361 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13363 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13364 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13365 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13366 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13367 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13370 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13371 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13372 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13374 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13375 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13376 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13377 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13379 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13380 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13381 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13382 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13383 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13384 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13385 domain matches this list.
13387 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13388 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13389 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13392 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13393 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13394 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13395 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13396 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13397 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13398 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13399 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13400 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13401 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13405 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13406 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13410 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13411 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13412 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13413 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13414 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13415 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13418 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13422 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13423 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13424 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13425 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13427 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13428 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13429 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13430 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13431 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13432 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13434 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13436 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13437 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13439 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13440 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13441 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13442 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13443 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13444 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13445 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13446 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13447 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13450 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13451 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13452 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13453 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13454 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13455 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13456 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13457 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13458 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13460 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13461 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13462 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13463 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13464 are examined. For example:
13466 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13467 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13468 postmaster@mydomain.example
13470 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13471 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13472 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13473 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13474 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13475 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13476 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13479 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13480 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13481 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13483 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13485 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13486 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13487 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13488 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13489 overrides the default.
13491 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13492 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13493 and warning messages. For example:
13495 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13497 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13498 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13499 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13500 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13504 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13505 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13506 .cindex "Exim group"
13507 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13508 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13509 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13510 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13511 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13515 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13516 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13517 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13518 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13519 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13520 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13522 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13523 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13524 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13525 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13528 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13529 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13530 .cindex "Exim user"
13531 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13532 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13533 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13534 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13536 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13537 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13538 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13539 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13542 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13543 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13544 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13545 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13548 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13549 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13551 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13552 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13554 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13555 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13556 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13557 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13558 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13559 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13560 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13561 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13562 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13563 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13567 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13568 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13569 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13570 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13571 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13572 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13573 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13574 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13577 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13578 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13579 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13580 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13584 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13585 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13586 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13587 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13588 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13589 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13590 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13591 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13592 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13593 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13594 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13595 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13596 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13597 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13598 logging that you require.
13601 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13603 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13604 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13605 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13606 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13607 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13608 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13609 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13610 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13612 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13613 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13614 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13617 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13618 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13619 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13620 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13622 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13626 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13627 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13630 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13631 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13632 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13634 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13635 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13636 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13638 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13639 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13640 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13642 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13643 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13644 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13645 implementations of TLS.
13647 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13648 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13649 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13650 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13651 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13652 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13656 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13657 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13658 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13659 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13660 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13661 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13662 sections are rejected.
13665 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13666 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13667 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13668 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13669 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13670 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13671 zero means &"no limit"&.
13676 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13677 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13678 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13679 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13680 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13681 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13682 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13683 if you want to do semantic checking.
13684 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13688 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13689 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13690 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13691 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13692 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13693 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13694 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13696 helo_allow_chars = _
13698 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13701 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13702 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13703 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13704 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13705 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13706 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13707 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13711 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13712 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13713 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13714 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13715 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13716 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13717 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13718 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13719 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13720 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13721 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13722 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13724 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13725 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13726 EHLO command either:
13729 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13731 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13732 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13733 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13734 calling host address, or
13736 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13737 available) yields the calling host address.
13740 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13741 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13742 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13744 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13745 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13746 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13747 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13748 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13749 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13750 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13751 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13752 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13755 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13756 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13757 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13758 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13759 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13760 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13761 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13762 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13763 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13765 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13766 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13767 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13768 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13769 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13771 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13772 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13773 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13774 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13777 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13778 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13779 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13780 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13781 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13782 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13783 default configuration file contains
13787 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13788 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13790 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13791 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13792 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13794 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13795 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13796 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13797 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13798 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13799 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13802 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13803 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13804 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13805 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13806 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13809 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13810 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13811 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13812 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13816 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13817 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13818 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13819 as soon as the connection is made.
13820 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13821 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13822 connections immediately.
13824 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13825 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13826 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13827 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13828 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13831 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13832 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13833 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13834 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13835 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13836 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13837 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13838 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13839 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13841 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13843 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13847 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13848 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13849 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13850 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13851 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13853 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13854 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13856 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13857 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13858 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13859 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13860 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13861 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13862 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13865 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13866 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13867 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13868 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13869 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13873 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13874 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13875 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13876 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13877 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13878 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13880 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13881 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13882 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13883 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13884 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13885 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13886 for frozen messages. For example,
13888 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13890 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13891 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13892 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13893 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13894 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13895 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13898 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13899 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13900 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13901 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13902 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13903 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13904 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13905 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13906 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13907 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13910 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13911 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13914 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13915 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13916 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13917 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13921 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
13922 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
13923 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
13924 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13925 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13926 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13927 and constrained to be a directory.
13930 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
13931 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
13932 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
13933 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13934 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13935 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13936 and constrained to be a file.
13939 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
13940 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
13941 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
13942 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
13943 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
13946 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
13947 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
13948 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
13949 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
13950 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
13951 identity to be proven.
13954 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
13955 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
13956 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
13957 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
13958 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
13961 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13962 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13963 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13964 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13965 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13969 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
13970 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
13971 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
13972 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
13973 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
13974 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
13978 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
13979 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
13980 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
13981 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
13982 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
13984 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
13985 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
13988 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13989 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13990 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13991 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13992 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13993 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13994 has been built with LDAP support.
13998 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13999 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14000 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14001 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14002 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14003 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14004 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14006 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14007 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14008 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14010 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14011 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14012 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14013 and the default qualify domain.
14015 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14016 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14017 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14018 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14020 .cindex "envelope sender"
14021 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14022 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14023 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14025 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14026 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14027 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14032 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14033 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14034 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14035 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14036 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14037 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14038 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14041 local_from_prefix = *-
14043 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14045 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14047 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14048 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14052 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14053 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14056 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14057 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14058 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14059 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14060 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14061 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14062 &%local_interfaces%& is
14064 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14066 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14068 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14071 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14072 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14073 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14074 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14075 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14076 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14077 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14078 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14082 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14083 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14084 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14085 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14086 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14087 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14088 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14089 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14094 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14095 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14096 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14097 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14098 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14099 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14100 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14101 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14102 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14103 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14104 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14105 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14106 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14107 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14108 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14112 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14113 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14114 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14115 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14116 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14117 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14118 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14119 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14120 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14121 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14122 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14123 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14124 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14125 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14128 .option log_selector main string unset
14129 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14130 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14131 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14132 minus characters. For example:
14134 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14136 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14137 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14140 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14141 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14142 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14143 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14144 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14145 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14146 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14147 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14148 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14149 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14150 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14151 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14152 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14155 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14156 .cindex "too many open files"
14157 .cindex "open files, too many"
14158 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14159 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14160 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14161 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14162 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14163 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14164 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14165 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14166 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14167 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14168 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14169 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14172 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14173 .cindex "length of login name"
14174 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14175 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14176 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14177 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14178 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14179 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14182 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14183 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14184 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14185 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14186 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14187 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14188 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14189 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14192 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14193 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14194 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14195 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14196 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14197 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14198 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14201 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14202 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14203 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14204 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14205 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14206 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14207 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14208 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14209 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14210 empty string, the option is ignored.
14213 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14214 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14215 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14216 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14217 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14218 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14219 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14220 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14221 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14222 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14223 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14224 colons will become hyphens.
14227 .option message_logs main boolean true
14228 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14229 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14230 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14231 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14232 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14233 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14234 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14235 which is not affected by this option.
14238 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14239 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14240 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14241 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14242 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14243 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14244 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14245 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14246 optionally followed by K or M.
14248 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14249 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14250 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14251 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14252 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14254 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14255 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14256 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14257 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14258 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14259 message that an individual transport can process.
14261 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14262 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14263 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14264 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14265 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14266 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14267 some problems may result.
14269 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14270 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14271 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14274 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14275 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14276 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14278 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14280 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14281 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14282 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14283 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14284 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14287 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14288 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14289 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14290 contains a full description of this facility.
14294 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14295 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14296 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14297 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14298 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14301 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14302 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14303 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14304 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14305 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14308 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14309 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14310 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14311 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14312 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14314 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14315 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14318 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14320 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14321 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14325 .option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14326 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14327 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14328 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14329 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
14330 value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
14331 remove all options with:
14333 openssl_options = -all
14335 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14336 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14337 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14338 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14339 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14340 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14341 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14343 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14344 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14345 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14346 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
14347 with the &%-bV%& flag.
14351 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
14355 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14356 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14357 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14358 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14359 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14362 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14363 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14364 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14365 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14366 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14367 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14368 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14369 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14370 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14371 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14374 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14375 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14376 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14377 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14378 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14379 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14380 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14383 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14384 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14385 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14388 .option perl_startup main string unset
14389 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14390 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14393 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14394 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14395 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14396 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14397 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14398 PostgreSQL support.
14401 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14402 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14403 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14404 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14405 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14408 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14410 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14412 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14413 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14414 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14417 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14418 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14419 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14420 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14421 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14422 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14423 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14424 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14425 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14428 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14429 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14430 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14431 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14432 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14433 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14434 volume of mail. Use with care!
14437 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14438 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14439 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14440 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14441 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14442 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14443 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14444 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14445 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14446 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14448 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14449 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14450 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14451 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14452 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14453 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14456 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14457 .cindex "printing characters"
14458 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14459 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14460 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14461 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14462 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14463 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14466 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14467 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14468 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14469 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14470 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14474 .option process_log_path main string unset
14475 .cindex "process log path"
14476 .cindex "log" "process log"
14477 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14478 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14479 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14480 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14481 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14482 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14483 different spool directories.
14486 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14490 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14491 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14492 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14495 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14496 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14497 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14498 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14499 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14500 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14501 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14502 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14503 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14505 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14506 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14507 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14508 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14509 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14510 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14511 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14514 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14515 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14516 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14520 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14521 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14522 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14523 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14524 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14525 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14526 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14527 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14530 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14532 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14533 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14534 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14537 .option queue_only main boolean false
14538 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14539 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14540 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14541 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14542 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14543 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14545 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14546 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14547 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14548 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14551 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14552 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14553 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14554 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14555 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14556 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14557 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14558 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14559 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14561 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14563 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14564 &_/some/file_& exists.
14567 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14568 .cindex "load average"
14569 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14570 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14571 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14572 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14573 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14574 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14575 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14578 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14579 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14580 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14581 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14584 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14585 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14586 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14587 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14588 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14589 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14590 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14591 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14592 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14593 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14594 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14595 re-evaluated for each message.
14598 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14599 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14600 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14601 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14602 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14603 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14606 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14607 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14608 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14609 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14610 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14611 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14612 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14613 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14614 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14615 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14616 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14617 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14618 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14622 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14623 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14624 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14625 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14626 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14627 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14628 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14629 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14630 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14632 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14633 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14634 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14635 the daemon's command line.
14637 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14638 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14639 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14640 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14641 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14642 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14643 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14644 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14645 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14646 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14647 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14648 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14649 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14653 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14654 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14655 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14656 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14657 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14658 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14659 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14661 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14662 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14663 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14664 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14665 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14666 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14667 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14668 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14669 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14670 header lines. The default setting is:
14673 received_header_text = Received: \
14674 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14675 {${if def:sender_ident \
14676 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14677 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14678 by $primary_hostname \
14679 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14680 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14681 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14682 ${if def:sender_address \
14683 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14684 id $message_exim_id\
14685 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14688 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14689 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14690 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14691 header lines such as the following:
14693 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14694 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14695 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14696 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14697 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14698 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14699 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14701 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14702 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14703 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14704 message was accepted.
14707 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14708 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14709 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14710 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14711 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14712 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14713 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14714 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14717 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14718 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14719 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14720 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14721 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14722 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14723 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14724 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14725 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14726 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14727 option was not set.
14730 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14731 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14732 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14733 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14734 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14735 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14736 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14737 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14740 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14741 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14742 RCPT commands in a single message.
14745 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14746 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14747 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14748 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14749 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14750 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14751 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14754 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14755 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14756 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14757 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14758 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14759 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14760 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14761 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14762 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14763 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14764 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14765 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14766 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14767 tagged with its process id.
14769 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14770 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14771 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14772 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14775 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14776 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14777 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14778 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14779 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14780 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14781 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14782 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14783 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14784 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14785 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14787 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14788 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14789 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14790 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14793 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14794 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14795 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14796 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14797 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14799 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14801 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14802 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14805 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14806 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14807 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14808 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14809 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14813 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14814 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14815 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14816 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14817 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14818 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14819 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14823 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14824 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14825 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14826 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14827 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14828 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14829 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14830 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14831 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14832 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14835 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14836 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14839 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14841 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14842 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14845 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14846 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14847 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14848 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14849 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14852 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14853 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14854 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14855 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14856 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14857 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14858 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14859 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14860 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14861 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14864 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14865 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14866 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14867 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14868 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14869 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14870 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14871 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14872 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14873 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14874 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14878 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14879 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14880 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14882 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14883 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14884 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14885 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14886 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14887 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14889 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14890 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14891 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14892 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14895 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14896 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14897 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14898 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14899 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14900 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14901 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14902 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14904 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14905 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14906 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14907 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14908 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14909 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14910 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14911 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14914 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14915 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14916 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14917 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14921 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14922 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14924 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14925 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14926 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14927 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14928 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14929 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14930 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14931 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14932 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14936 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14937 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14938 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14939 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14940 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14941 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14942 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14943 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14944 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14945 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14946 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14948 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14949 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14950 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14951 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14952 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14953 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14957 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14958 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14959 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14960 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14961 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14962 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14963 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14964 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14965 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14966 to all messages received in the same connection.
14968 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14969 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14970 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14971 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14974 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14975 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14977 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14978 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14979 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14980 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14981 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14982 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14983 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14984 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14985 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14986 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14987 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14988 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14989 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14992 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14993 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14994 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14995 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14996 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14997 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14998 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14999 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15000 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15001 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15002 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15005 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15006 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15007 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15008 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15011 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15012 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15013 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15014 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15015 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15016 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15017 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15018 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15019 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15021 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15022 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15023 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15024 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15026 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15027 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15028 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15029 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15030 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15033 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15034 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15037 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15038 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15039 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15040 &%helo_data%& value.
15042 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15043 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15044 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15045 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15046 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15047 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15048 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15050 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15051 $version_number $tod_full
15053 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15054 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15055 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15056 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15057 multiline response).
15060 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15061 .cindex "checking disk space"
15062 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15063 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15064 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15065 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15066 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15067 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15068 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15071 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15072 .cindex "connection backlog"
15073 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15074 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15075 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15076 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15077 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15078 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15079 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15080 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15081 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15082 attacks by SYN flooding.
15085 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15086 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15087 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15088 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15089 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15090 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15091 fewer, but they still exist.
15093 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15094 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15095 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15096 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15097 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15098 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15099 does detect many instances.
15101 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15102 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15103 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15104 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15108 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15109 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15110 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15111 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15112 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15113 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15114 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15115 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15118 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15119 $sender_host_address
15121 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15122 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15123 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15124 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15125 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15129 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15130 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15131 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15132 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15133 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15136 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15137 .cindex "load average"
15138 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15139 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15140 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15141 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15142 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15143 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15147 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15148 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15149 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15150 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15151 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15153 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15155 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15156 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15157 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15158 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15159 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15161 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15162 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15163 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15164 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15165 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15166 not count towards the limit.
15170 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15171 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15172 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15173 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15174 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15177 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15178 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15182 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15183 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15184 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15185 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15186 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15187 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15190 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15191 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15192 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15193 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15195 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15196 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15197 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15198 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15202 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15204 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15205 fractional parts are allowed here.
15207 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15209 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15210 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15213 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15214 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15216 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15217 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15219 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15220 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15221 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15222 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15225 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15226 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15229 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15230 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15233 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15234 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15235 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15236 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15237 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15238 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15239 the message is abandoned.
15240 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15242 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15243 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15245 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15246 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15250 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15251 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15252 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15253 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15254 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15257 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15258 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15259 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15262 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15263 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15264 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15265 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15266 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15267 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15268 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15269 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15270 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15271 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15273 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15274 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15277 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15278 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15279 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15280 The default value is
15284 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15288 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15289 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15290 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15291 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15292 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15293 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15294 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15295 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15296 arrival of the message.
15298 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15299 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15300 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15301 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15302 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15304 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15305 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15306 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15307 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15308 automatically deleted.
15310 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15311 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15312 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15313 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15314 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15315 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15316 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15317 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15318 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15321 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15322 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15323 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15324 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15325 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15326 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15327 &$primary_hostname$&.
15329 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15330 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15331 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15332 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15333 as failures in the configuration file.
15335 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15336 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15338 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15339 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15340 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15341 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15343 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15344 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15345 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15346 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15347 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15348 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15350 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15351 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15352 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15353 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15354 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15355 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15356 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15359 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15360 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15361 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15362 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15363 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15364 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15365 domain causes a syntax error.
15366 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15370 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15371 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15372 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15373 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15374 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15375 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15376 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15377 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15378 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15379 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15380 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15381 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15384 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15385 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15386 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15387 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15388 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15389 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15390 details of Exim's logging.
15394 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15395 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15396 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15397 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15398 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15402 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15403 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15404 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15405 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15406 details of Exim's logging.
15409 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15410 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15411 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15412 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15413 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15414 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15415 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15416 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15417 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15418 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15419 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15422 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15423 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15424 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15425 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15426 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15427 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15430 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15431 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15432 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15433 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15434 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15436 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15437 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15438 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15439 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15440 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15442 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15443 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15444 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15445 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15446 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15447 contains the pipe command.
15450 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15451 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15452 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15453 is used in a system filter.
15456 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15457 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15458 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15459 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15460 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15461 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15462 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15463 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15464 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15465 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15467 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15468 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15469 transport option overrides.
15472 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15473 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15474 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15475 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15476 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15477 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15478 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15479 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15480 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15481 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15482 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15483 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15487 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15488 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15489 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15490 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15491 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15492 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15493 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15494 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15495 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15496 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15498 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15499 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15500 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15503 .option timezone main string unset
15504 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15505 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15506 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15507 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15508 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15512 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15513 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15514 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15515 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15516 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15517 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15520 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15521 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15522 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15523 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15524 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15525 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15526 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15527 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15530 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15531 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15532 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15533 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15534 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15535 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15536 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15538 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15539 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15540 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15541 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15544 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15545 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15546 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15547 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15548 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15551 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15552 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15553 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15554 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15555 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15556 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15559 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15560 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15561 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15562 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15563 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15567 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15568 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15569 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15570 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15571 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15572 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15573 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15576 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15577 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15578 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15579 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15580 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15581 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15585 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15586 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15587 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15588 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15589 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15590 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15591 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15592 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15593 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15594 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15595 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15598 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15599 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15600 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15601 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15604 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15605 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15606 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15607 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15608 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15609 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15610 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15611 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15612 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15614 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15615 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15616 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15617 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15618 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15619 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15622 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15623 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15624 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15625 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15626 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15627 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15628 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15629 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15631 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15632 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15633 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15634 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15635 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15636 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15637 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15639 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15640 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15641 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15642 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15643 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15644 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15645 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15648 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15652 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15653 .cindex "trusted groups"
15654 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15655 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15656 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15657 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15658 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15659 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15660 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15663 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15664 .cindex "trusted users"
15665 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15666 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15667 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15668 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15669 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15670 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15671 Exim user are trusted.
15673 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15674 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15675 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15676 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15677 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15678 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15679 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15680 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15681 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15684 .option unknown_username main string unset
15685 See &%unknown_login%&.
15687 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15688 .cindex "trusted users"
15689 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15690 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15691 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15692 .cindex "envelope sender"
15693 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15694 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15695 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15696 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15697 is used) is ignored.
15699 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15700 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15702 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15704 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15705 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15706 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15707 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15708 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15709 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15710 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15711 followed by a hyphen
15712 by a setting like this:
15714 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15716 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15717 restriction, you can use
15719 untrusted_set_sender = *
15721 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15722 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15723 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15724 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15725 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15726 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15727 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15728 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15730 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15731 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15732 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15733 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15737 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15738 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15739 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15740 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15741 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15742 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15743 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15744 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15745 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15746 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15748 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15749 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15751 The pattern can be seen by running
15753 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15755 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15756 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15757 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15758 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15759 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15760 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15763 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15764 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15767 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15768 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15769 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15770 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15771 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15772 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15773 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15774 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15777 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15778 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15779 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15780 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15781 .ecindex IIDconfima
15782 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15790 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15791 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15792 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15793 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15794 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15796 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15797 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15798 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15799 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15800 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15804 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15805 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15806 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15807 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15808 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15809 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15810 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15812 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15813 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15814 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15815 routers, and the eventual transport.
15817 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15818 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15819 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15820 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15821 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15823 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15824 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15825 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15826 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15827 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15829 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15830 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15831 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15833 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15835 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15837 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15839 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15840 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15842 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15843 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15844 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15845 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15846 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15847 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15848 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15852 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15854 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15855 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15856 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15857 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15858 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15863 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15864 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15865 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15866 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15867 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15868 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15869 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15870 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15871 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15872 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15875 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15877 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15880 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15882 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15883 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15884 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15885 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15888 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15889 .cindex "case of local parts"
15890 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15891 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15892 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15893 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15894 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15895 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15896 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15899 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15900 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15901 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15902 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15903 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15904 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15905 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15906 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15907 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15909 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15910 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15911 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15912 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15916 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15917 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15918 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15919 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15921 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15922 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15923 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15924 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15925 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15926 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15927 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15928 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15929 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15930 the router is skipped.
15932 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15933 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15934 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15935 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15936 setting to achieve this. For example:
15938 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15940 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15941 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15942 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15946 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15947 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15948 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15949 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15950 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15951 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15952 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15953 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15955 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15956 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15958 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
15959 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
15961 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15962 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15963 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15965 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15967 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15969 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15972 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
15974 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15975 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
15979 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15980 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15981 be specified using &%condition%&.
15984 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15985 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15986 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15987 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15988 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15989 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15990 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15991 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15992 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15993 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15994 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15995 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15999 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16000 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16001 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16002 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16003 transport option of the same name.
16006 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16007 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16008 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16009 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16010 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16011 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16012 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16013 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16017 .option driver routers string unset
16018 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16023 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16024 .cindex "envelope sender"
16025 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16026 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16027 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16028 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16029 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16030 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16031 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16033 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16034 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16035 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16038 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16039 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16040 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16041 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16043 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16044 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16045 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16046 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16052 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16053 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16054 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16055 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16056 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16058 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16059 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16060 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16061 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16062 setting &%return_path%&.
16064 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16065 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16066 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16070 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16071 .cindex "address" "testing"
16072 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16073 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16074 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16075 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16076 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16077 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16078 on for the system alias file.
16079 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16082 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16083 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16084 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16088 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16089 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16090 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16091 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16095 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16096 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16097 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16101 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16102 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16103 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16107 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16108 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16109 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16110 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16111 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16112 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16113 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16114 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16115 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16117 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16118 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16119 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16120 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16121 transport for further details.
16124 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16125 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16126 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16127 .cindex "transport" "local"
16128 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16129 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16130 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16132 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16133 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16134 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16135 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16136 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16140 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16141 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16142 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16143 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16144 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16145 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16146 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16147 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16148 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16149 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16150 &"see"& the added header lines.
16152 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16153 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16154 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16155 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16157 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16158 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16160 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16161 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16162 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16163 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16164 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16165 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16166 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16167 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16168 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16169 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16173 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16174 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16175 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16176 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16177 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16178 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16179 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16180 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16181 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16182 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16183 &"see"& the original header lines.
16185 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16186 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16187 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16190 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16191 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16193 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16194 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16195 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16196 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16199 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16200 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16201 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16202 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16203 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16204 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16205 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16208 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16212 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16214 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16215 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16216 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16217 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16218 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16219 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16221 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16222 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16224 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16225 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16227 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16228 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16230 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16231 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16232 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16233 domain that is being routed.
16235 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16236 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16239 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16240 .cindex "additional groups"
16241 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16242 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16243 .cindex "transport" "local"
16244 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16245 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16246 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16247 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16248 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16252 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16253 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16254 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16255 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16256 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16257 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16260 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16261 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16262 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16263 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16264 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16265 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16266 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16267 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16268 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16270 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16271 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16272 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16273 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16274 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16275 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16276 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16277 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16278 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16279 the relevant transport.
16281 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16282 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16283 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16286 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16287 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16288 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16289 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16290 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16294 local_part_prefix = real-
16296 transport = local_delivery
16298 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16299 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16301 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16302 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16305 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16306 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16307 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16308 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16311 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16312 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16316 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16317 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16318 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16319 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16320 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16321 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16322 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16323 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16324 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16328 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16329 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16333 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16334 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16335 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16336 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16337 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16339 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16340 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16343 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16345 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16346 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16347 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16348 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16349 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16350 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16351 each virtual domain:
16355 local_parts = postmaster
16356 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16360 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16361 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16362 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16363 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16364 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16365 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16366 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16367 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16368 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16369 redirect addresses.
16373 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16374 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16375 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16376 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16377 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16378 delivery to be deferred.
16380 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16381 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16383 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16384 means of the setting
16388 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16389 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16390 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16392 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16393 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16394 controls what happens next.
16397 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16398 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16399 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16400 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16401 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16402 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16403 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16404 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16406 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16407 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16408 applies to all of them.
16412 .option pass_router routers string unset
16413 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16414 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16415 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16416 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16417 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16418 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16419 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16420 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16421 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16422 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16426 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16427 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16428 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16429 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16430 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16431 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16433 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16434 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16435 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16436 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16440 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16441 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16442 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16443 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16444 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16445 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16446 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16448 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16449 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16450 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16451 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16453 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16454 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16455 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16456 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16457 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16460 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16461 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16464 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16465 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16466 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16467 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16468 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16469 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16470 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16471 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16473 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16474 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16475 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16476 operates as follows:
16478 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16479 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16480 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16481 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16484 require_files = mail:/some/file
16485 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16487 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16488 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16490 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16491 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16492 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16493 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16495 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16496 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16497 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16498 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16499 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16501 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16502 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16503 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16504 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16505 check again in that process.
16507 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16508 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16509 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16510 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16511 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16512 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16513 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16515 require_files = +/some/file
16517 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16518 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16519 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16523 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16524 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16525 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16526 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16527 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16528 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16529 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16530 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16533 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16534 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16535 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16536 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16537 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16540 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16541 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16542 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16546 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16547 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16548 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16550 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16551 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16552 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16553 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16554 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16555 cause the router to defer.
16557 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16558 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16560 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16562 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16563 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16565 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16566 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16567 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16568 of these values that is set:
16571 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16573 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16575 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16577 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16580 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16581 router, but not for the transport.
16585 .option self routers string freeze
16586 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16587 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16588 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16589 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16590 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16591 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16593 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16594 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16595 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16596 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16597 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16599 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16600 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16601 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16602 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16603 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16608 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16610 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16611 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16612 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16613 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16615 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16616 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16617 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16622 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16623 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16624 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16625 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16626 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16627 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16633 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16634 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16635 be passed to the next router.
16638 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16641 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16642 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16643 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16644 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16645 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16646 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16651 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16652 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16653 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16654 address matches something on the list.
16655 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16658 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16659 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16660 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16661 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16662 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16663 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16664 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16668 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16669 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16670 .cindex "packet radio"
16671 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16672 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16673 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16674 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16675 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16676 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16677 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16678 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16680 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16681 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16682 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16683 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16684 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16685 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16686 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16687 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16688 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16689 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16691 translate_ip_address = \
16692 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16695 The file would contain lines like
16697 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16698 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16700 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16705 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16706 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16707 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16708 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16709 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16710 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16711 delivery is deferred.
16713 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16714 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16715 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16719 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16720 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16721 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16722 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16723 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16724 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16725 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16726 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16727 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16728 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16729 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16735 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16736 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16737 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16738 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16739 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16740 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16741 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16742 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16743 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16744 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16746 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16747 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16748 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16749 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16750 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16752 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16758 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16759 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16760 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16761 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16762 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16763 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16764 delivery to be deferred.
16766 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16767 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16768 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16769 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16770 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16771 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16773 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16774 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16775 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16776 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16777 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16778 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16779 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16780 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16782 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16783 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16784 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16785 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16786 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16787 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16788 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16789 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16790 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16791 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16793 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16794 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16795 subsequent routers.
16798 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16799 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16800 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16801 .cindex "transport" "local"
16802 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16803 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16804 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16805 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16806 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16807 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16808 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16809 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16810 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16811 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16812 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16813 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16817 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16818 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16819 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16822 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16823 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16825 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16826 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16827 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16828 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16829 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16830 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16832 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16833 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16834 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16838 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16839 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16841 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16842 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16846 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16847 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16848 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16849 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16851 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16852 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16862 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16863 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16864 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16865 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16866 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16867 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16868 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16869 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16870 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16874 domains = mydomain.example
16876 transport = local_delivery
16878 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16879 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16880 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16881 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16891 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16892 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16893 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16894 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16895 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16896 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16898 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16899 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16900 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16901 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16904 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16905 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16906 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16907 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16908 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16909 generic option, the router declines.
16911 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16912 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16913 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16915 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16916 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16917 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16918 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16919 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16920 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16923 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16924 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16925 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16926 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16927 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16928 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16930 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16931 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16932 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16933 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16934 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16935 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16936 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16937 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16938 case routing fails.
16943 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16944 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16945 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16947 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16948 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16949 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16950 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16951 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16952 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16953 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16956 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16957 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16958 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16959 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16960 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16961 required. For example,
16965 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16966 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16967 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16968 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16969 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16972 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16973 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16974 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16975 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16976 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16977 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16979 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16980 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16981 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16982 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16983 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16984 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16985 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16986 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16988 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16989 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16993 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16994 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16995 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16996 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16997 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16998 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16999 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17002 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17004 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17005 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17006 the address record.
17009 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17010 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17011 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17012 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17017 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17018 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17019 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17020 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17021 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17022 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17023 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17024 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17025 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17030 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17031 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17032 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17033 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17034 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17035 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17036 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17037 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17038 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17039 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17040 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17042 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17043 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17046 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17047 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17048 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17049 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17050 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17054 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17055 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17056 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17057 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17058 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17059 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17060 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17061 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17063 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17064 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17065 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17066 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17067 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17068 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17069 without processing them independently,
17070 provided the following conditions are met:
17073 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17074 &%headers_remove%&.
17076 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17083 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17084 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17085 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17086 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17087 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17088 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17089 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17090 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17091 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17092 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17094 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17095 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17100 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17101 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17102 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17103 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17108 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17109 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17110 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17111 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17114 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17116 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17117 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17118 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17119 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17120 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17121 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17124 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17125 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17126 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17127 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17128 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17130 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17131 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17132 such as that implied by
17136 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17137 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17138 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17139 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17152 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17153 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17154 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17155 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17156 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17157 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17158 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17159 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17160 router handles the address
17164 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17165 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17166 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17168 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17170 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17171 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17173 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17174 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17175 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17176 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17178 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17179 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17180 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17181 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17188 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17189 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17190 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17191 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17192 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17193 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17196 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17198 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17200 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17201 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17202 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17203 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17204 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17205 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17206 must not be specified for it.
17208 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17209 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17210 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17211 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17212 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17213 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17214 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17217 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17218 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17219 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17220 delivery to the address is deferred.
17223 .option port iplookup integer 0
17224 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17225 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17229 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17230 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17231 protocols is to be used.
17234 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17235 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17238 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17240 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17241 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17244 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17245 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17246 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17247 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17248 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17249 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17250 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17251 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17254 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17255 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17256 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17257 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17258 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17259 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17260 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17261 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17262 following could be used:
17264 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17265 reroute = $local_part@$1
17268 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17269 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17270 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17271 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17279 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17280 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17281 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17282 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17283 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17284 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17285 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17286 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17287 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17288 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17290 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17291 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17292 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17293 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17294 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17295 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17296 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17299 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17300 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17301 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17302 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17303 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17304 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17305 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17308 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17309 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17310 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17311 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17312 below, following the list of private options.
17315 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17317 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17318 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17320 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17321 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17323 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17324 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17325 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17326 of the following values:
17335 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17336 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17337 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17340 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17341 router only if &%more%& is true.
17343 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17344 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17345 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17346 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17348 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17349 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17350 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17353 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17354 .cindex "randomized host list"
17355 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17356 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17357 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17358 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17359 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17360 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17361 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17362 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17364 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17365 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17366 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17367 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17369 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17371 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17372 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17373 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17374 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17375 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17378 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17379 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17380 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17383 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17385 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17386 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17390 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17391 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17392 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17393 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17396 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17397 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17398 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17399 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17400 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17401 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17402 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17403 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17405 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17406 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17407 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17408 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17409 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17410 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17411 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17412 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17417 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17418 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17419 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17420 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17421 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17422 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17424 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17426 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17430 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17431 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17433 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17434 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17435 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17436 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17437 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17438 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17439 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17440 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17441 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17442 in a &%route_list%&).
17444 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17445 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17446 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17447 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17451 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17452 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17453 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17454 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17455 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17456 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17457 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17460 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17461 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17463 This data can be accessed by setting
17465 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17467 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17468 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17469 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17470 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17471 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17476 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17477 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17478 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17479 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17480 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17481 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17482 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17484 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17485 variables are set during its expansion:
17488 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17489 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17490 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17492 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17495 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17497 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17500 .vindex "&$value$&"
17501 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17502 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17504 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17508 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17509 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17513 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17514 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17515 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17516 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17517 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17518 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17521 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17522 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17523 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17525 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17526 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17529 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17530 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17531 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17532 number follows. For example:
17534 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17538 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17539 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17540 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17541 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17542 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17545 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17546 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17547 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17548 records in the DNS. For example:
17550 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17552 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17555 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17557 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17558 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17559 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17560 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17561 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17562 happens is controlled by the
17563 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17564 &%self%& option of the router.
17566 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17567 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17568 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17569 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17570 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17571 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17572 defined by MX preferences.
17574 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17575 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17576 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17578 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17579 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17580 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17581 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17583 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17584 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17587 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17588 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17589 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17591 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17592 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17596 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17597 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17598 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17599 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17600 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17601 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17602 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17605 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17606 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17608 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17609 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17611 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17612 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17613 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17615 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17616 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17617 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17622 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17623 domain2 host4:host5
17625 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17626 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17627 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17628 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17631 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17632 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17633 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17634 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17639 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17640 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17643 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17644 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17648 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17649 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17650 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17653 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17654 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17655 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17656 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17658 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17660 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17661 your first router something like this:
17664 driver = manualroute
17665 domains = !+local_domains
17666 transport = remote_smtp
17667 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17669 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17670 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17671 they are tried in order
17672 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17673 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17676 driver = manualroute
17677 transport = remote_smtp
17678 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17680 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17681 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17682 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17683 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17684 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17685 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17686 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17687 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17690 .cindex "mail hub example"
17691 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17692 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17693 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17694 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17695 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17696 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17697 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17698 lookup is easier to manage.
17700 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17701 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17705 driver = manualroute
17706 transport = remote_smtp
17707 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17709 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17710 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17711 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17712 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17713 domain can be used to find the host:
17716 driver = manualroute
17717 transport = remote_smtp
17718 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17720 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17721 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17722 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17726 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17727 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17728 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17729 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17730 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17731 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17734 driver = manualroute
17735 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17736 route_list = saved.domain.example
17738 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17739 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17740 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17743 driver = manualroute
17745 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17746 *.saved.domain2.example \
17747 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17750 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17752 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17753 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17754 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17755 the address if the lookup fails.
17758 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17759 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17760 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17761 one way it can be done:
17767 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17768 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17769 return_fail_output = true
17774 driver = manualroute
17776 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17778 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17780 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17782 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17783 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17784 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17786 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17787 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17799 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17800 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17801 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17802 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17803 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17804 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17805 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17806 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17807 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17808 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17810 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17812 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17813 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17814 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17815 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17816 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17819 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17820 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17821 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17822 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17823 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17824 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17827 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17828 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17829 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17830 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17831 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17832 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17833 not set, a value for the gid also.
17835 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17836 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17837 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17838 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17839 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17840 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17844 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17845 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17846 before running the command.
17849 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17850 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17851 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17855 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17856 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17857 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17858 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17859 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17862 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17865 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17866 &%no_more%& is set.
17868 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17869 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17870 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17871 included in the SMTP response.
17873 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17874 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17875 included in any SMTP response.
17877 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17879 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17880 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17882 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17883 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17884 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17887 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17888 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17891 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17892 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17894 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17895 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17896 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17897 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17899 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17900 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17901 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17902 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17903 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17905 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17906 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17907 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17908 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17909 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17911 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17912 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17913 variable. For example, this return line
17915 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17917 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17918 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17919 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17920 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17928 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17929 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17930 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17931 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17932 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17933 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17934 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17935 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17936 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17937 redirected in several different ways:
17940 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17943 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17945 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17947 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17949 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17951 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17953 It can be discarded.
17956 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17957 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17958 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17959 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17963 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17964 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17965 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17966 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17967 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17968 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17972 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17974 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17975 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17976 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17977 cause delivery to be deferred.
17979 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17980 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17985 file = $home/.forward
17988 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17989 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17990 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17991 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17996 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17997 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17998 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17999 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18002 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18003 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18004 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18005 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18007 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18008 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18009 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18010 saves some resources.
18018 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18019 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18020 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18021 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18022 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18025 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18026 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18027 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18028 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18029 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18030 document is intended for use by end users.
18032 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18033 described in the next section.
18036 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18037 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18038 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18039 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18040 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18044 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18045 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18046 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18047 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18048 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18049 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18050 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18051 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18052 commas or newlines.
18053 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18056 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18057 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18058 next newline character is ignored.
18060 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18061 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18062 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18063 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18066 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18067 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18068 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18069 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18070 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18071 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18074 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18078 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18079 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18080 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18081 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18082 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18083 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18084 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18085 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18086 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18087 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18088 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18090 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18091 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18092 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18093 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18094 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18096 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18098 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18099 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18100 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18101 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18102 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18105 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18106 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18107 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18108 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18109 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18111 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18112 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18117 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18118 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18121 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18123 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18124 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18125 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18126 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18127 should really contain
18129 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18131 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18132 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18133 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18137 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18138 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18139 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18142 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18143 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18144 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18145 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18146 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18147 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18148 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18150 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18151 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18152 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18153 in double quotes, for example:
18155 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18157 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18158 quote just the command. An item such as
18160 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18162 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18165 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18166 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18167 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18168 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18170 /home/world/minbari
18172 is treated as a file name, but
18174 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18176 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18177 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18178 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18179 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18181 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18182 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18184 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18185 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18186 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18187 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18190 .cindex "included address list"
18191 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18192 If an item is of the form
18194 :include:<path name>
18196 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18197 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18198 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18199 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18200 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18201 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18203 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18205 It must be given as
18207 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18210 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18211 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18212 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18213 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18214 .cindex "black hole"
18215 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18216 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18217 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18218 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18220 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18221 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18222 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18223 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18227 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18228 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18229 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18230 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18231 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18232 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18233 redirection items of the form
18238 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18239 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18240 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18241 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18243 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18245 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18247 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18248 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18250 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18251 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18252 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18254 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18255 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18256 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18257 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18258 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18259 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18260 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18261 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18262 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18265 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18266 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18267 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18268 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18270 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18271 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18272 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18273 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18274 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18276 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18277 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18278 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18279 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18280 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18284 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18285 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18286 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18287 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18288 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18289 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18290 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18294 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18295 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18296 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18297 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18298 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18299 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18300 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18301 aliasing scheme of the type
18303 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18307 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18308 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18309 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18312 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18313 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18315 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18316 the pipes are distinct.
18320 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18321 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18322 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18323 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18324 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18325 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18326 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18327 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18328 can be used to avoid this.
18331 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18332 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18333 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18334 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18335 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18336 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18337 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18341 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18343 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18344 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18347 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18348 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18349 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18352 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18353 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18354 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18355 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18358 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18359 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18360 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18361 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18362 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18363 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18364 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18366 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18367 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18370 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18371 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18372 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18373 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18374 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18378 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18379 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18380 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18381 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18382 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18383 let ordinary users do.
18387 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18388 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18389 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18390 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18391 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18392 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18394 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18395 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18396 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18397 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18398 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18399 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18401 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18403 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18404 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18405 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18406 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18407 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18408 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18409 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18410 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18413 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18414 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18415 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18416 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18417 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18418 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18419 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18420 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18424 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18425 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18426 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18427 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18428 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18429 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18432 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18433 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18434 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18435 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18436 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18437 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18439 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18440 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18441 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18443 data = #Exim filter\n\
18444 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18446 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18447 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18448 choice into a newline.
18451 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18452 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18453 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18454 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18455 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18458 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18459 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18460 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18461 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18462 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18463 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18464 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18465 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18467 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18468 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18469 runs a check on the containing directory,
18470 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18471 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18472 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18473 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18474 not, the router declines.
18477 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18478 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18479 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18480 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18481 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18482 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18483 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18486 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18487 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18488 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18489 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18490 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18493 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18494 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18498 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18499 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18500 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18505 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18506 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18507 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18508 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18509 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18510 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18511 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18512 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18513 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18516 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18517 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18518 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18519 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18522 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18523 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18524 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18525 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18527 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18528 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18529 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18530 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18531 &_.forward_& files).
18534 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18535 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18536 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18539 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18540 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18541 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18542 of the embedded Perl support.
18545 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18546 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18547 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18550 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18551 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18552 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18555 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18556 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18557 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18558 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18559 &%one_time%& is set.
18562 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18563 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18564 to make use of &%run%& items.
18567 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18568 If this option is true, items of the form
18570 :include:<path name>
18572 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18575 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18576 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18577 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18578 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18579 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18582 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18583 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18584 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18587 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18588 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18589 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18590 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18591 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18596 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18597 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18598 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18599 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18600 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18601 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18602 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18605 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18607 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18608 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18609 file did not exist.
18612 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18614 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18615 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18616 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18618 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18619 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18620 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18621 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18622 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18623 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18624 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18625 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18629 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18630 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18631 redirection list must start with this directory.
18634 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18635 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18636 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18639 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18640 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18641 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18642 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18643 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18644 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18645 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18646 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18647 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18648 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18649 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18650 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18651 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18652 before they subscribed.
18654 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18655 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18656 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18657 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18660 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18661 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18662 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18663 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18665 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18666 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18667 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18669 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18672 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18673 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18674 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18675 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18676 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18680 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18681 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18682 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18683 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18684 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18685 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18686 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18687 See &%check_owner%& above.
18690 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18691 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18692 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18693 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18696 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18697 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18698 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18699 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18700 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18701 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18702 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18705 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18706 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18707 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18708 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18709 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18710 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18711 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18712 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18714 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18715 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18716 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18719 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18720 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18721 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18722 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18723 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18724 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18725 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18726 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18727 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18728 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18731 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18732 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18733 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18734 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18735 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18736 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18739 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18740 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18741 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18742 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18743 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18744 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18747 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18748 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18749 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18750 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18751 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18754 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18755 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18756 :subaddress part of an address.
18758 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18759 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18760 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18761 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18764 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18765 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18766 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18767 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18768 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18769 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18770 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18774 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18775 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18776 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18777 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18778 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18779 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18780 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18781 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18782 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18783 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18784 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18785 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18786 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18787 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18788 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18789 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18791 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18792 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18793 the following routers.
18795 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18796 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18797 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18798 so it is passed to the following routers.
18800 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18801 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18802 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18803 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18805 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18806 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18807 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18808 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18814 file = $home/.forward
18815 file_transport = address_file
18816 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18817 reply_transport = address_reply
18820 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18821 syntax_errors_text = \
18822 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18823 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18824 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18825 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18826 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18827 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18828 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18829 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18830 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18831 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18833 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18834 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18835 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18840 local_part_prefix = real-
18841 transport = local_delivery
18843 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18844 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18846 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18847 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18851 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18852 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18855 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18856 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18857 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18858 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18868 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18869 "Environment for local transports"
18870 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18871 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18872 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18873 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18874 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18875 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18876 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18878 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18879 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18880 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18881 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18883 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18884 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18885 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18886 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18887 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18891 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18892 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18893 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18894 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18895 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18896 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18897 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18900 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18901 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18905 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18907 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18908 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18909 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18910 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18915 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18916 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18917 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18918 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18919 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18920 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18921 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18922 group (set by the transport). For example:
18925 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18929 transport = group_delivery
18932 # This transport overrides the group
18934 driver = appendfile
18935 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18938 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18939 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18940 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18943 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18944 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18945 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18946 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18947 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18948 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18950 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18951 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18952 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18953 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18954 original gid is also used.
18956 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18957 following that is set is used:
18960 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18962 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18964 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18965 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18967 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18969 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18970 the uid is the creator's uid;
18972 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18975 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18976 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18977 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18978 The first of the following that is set is used:
18981 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18983 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18985 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18987 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18992 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18993 &%never_users%& list.
18999 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19000 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19001 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19002 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19003 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19004 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19005 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19006 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19007 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19008 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19011 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19013 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19015 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19017 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19020 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19023 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19025 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19029 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19030 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19031 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19035 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19036 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19037 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19038 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19039 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19040 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19041 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19042 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19043 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19044 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19045 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19046 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19047 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19048 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19059 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19060 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19061 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19062 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19063 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19066 .option body_only transports boolean false
19067 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19068 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19069 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19070 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19071 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19072 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19073 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19074 automatically suppress them.
19077 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19078 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19079 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19080 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19081 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19082 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19085 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19086 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19087 deliveries by the transport or for any
19088 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19089 what you are doing.
19092 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19093 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19094 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19095 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19097 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19098 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19099 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19100 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19101 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19102 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19106 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19107 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19108 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19109 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19110 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19111 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19112 safely be resent to other recipients.
19115 .option driver transports string unset
19116 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19117 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19120 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19121 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19122 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19123 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19124 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19125 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19126 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19127 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19128 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19129 resent to other recipients.
19132 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19133 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19134 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19135 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19136 &%user%& (see below).
19139 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19140 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19141 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19142 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19143 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19144 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19145 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19146 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19147 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19151 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19152 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19153 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19154 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19155 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19156 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19157 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19158 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19161 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19162 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19163 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19164 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19165 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19166 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19167 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19168 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19169 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19173 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19174 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19175 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19176 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19177 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19178 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19179 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19180 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19183 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19186 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19187 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19188 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19189 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19190 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19191 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19192 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19193 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19194 change envelope recipients at this time.
19197 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19198 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19200 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19201 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19202 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19203 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19204 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19205 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19206 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19210 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19211 .cindex "additional groups"
19212 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19213 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19214 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19215 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19216 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19219 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19220 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19221 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19222 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19223 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19224 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19225 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19226 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19227 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19228 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19229 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19230 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19231 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19236 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19237 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19238 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19239 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19240 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19241 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19242 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19243 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19246 local_part_prefix = *-
19248 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19251 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19253 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19254 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19255 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19256 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19257 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19260 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19261 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19262 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19263 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19264 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19265 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19266 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19267 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19268 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19270 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19271 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19272 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19273 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19275 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19276 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19277 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19280 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19281 .cindex "envelope sender"
19282 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19283 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19284 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19285 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19286 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19287 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19288 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19289 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19290 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19292 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19293 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19295 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19296 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19297 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19298 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19299 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19300 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19301 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19303 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19304 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19305 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19306 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19307 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19311 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19312 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19313 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19314 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19315 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19316 have easy access to it.
19318 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19319 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19320 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19321 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19322 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19326 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19327 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19330 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19331 .cindex "shadow transport"
19332 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19333 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19334 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19336 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19337 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19338 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19339 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19340 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19341 cause a log line to be written.
19343 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19344 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19345 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19346 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19347 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19350 ST=<shadow transport name>
19352 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19353 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19354 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19355 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19356 headers that some sites insist on.
19359 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19360 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19361 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19362 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19363 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19364 individual users or via a system filter.
19366 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19367 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19368 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19369 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19370 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19372 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19373 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19374 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19375 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19376 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19377 &(pipe)& transports.
19379 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19380 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19381 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19382 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19383 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19385 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19386 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19387 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19388 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19390 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19391 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19392 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19393 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19394 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19395 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19397 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19398 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19399 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19400 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19401 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19402 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19403 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19404 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19406 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19407 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19408 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19409 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19410 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19411 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19412 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19413 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19414 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19415 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19418 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19419 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19420 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19421 which the message is being sent. For example:
19423 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19424 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19427 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19428 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19429 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19431 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19432 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19433 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19436 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19438 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19439 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19440 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19441 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19442 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19443 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19445 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19446 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19447 arguments. Consider this example:
19449 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19450 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19452 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19453 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19455 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19456 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19460 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19461 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19462 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19463 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19464 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19465 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19466 bounced from a transport filter.
19468 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19469 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19470 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19473 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19474 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19475 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19476 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19477 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19478 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19479 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19480 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19481 becomes a temporary error.
19484 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19485 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19486 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19487 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19488 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19489 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19490 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19493 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19494 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19495 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19497 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19498 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19499 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19500 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19502 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19503 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19504 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19514 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19516 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19517 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19518 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19519 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19520 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19521 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19522 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19524 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19525 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19526 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19527 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19528 local transport, for example:
19531 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19532 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19533 recipients saves space.
19535 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19536 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19538 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19539 to a scanner program or
19540 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19544 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19545 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19546 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19548 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19549 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19550 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19551 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19552 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19553 to certain conditions:
19556 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19557 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19558 batching is possible.
19560 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19561 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19562 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19564 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19565 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19566 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19567 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19568 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19571 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19572 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19573 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19577 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19578 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19579 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19580 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19581 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19582 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19583 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19586 escape_string = ".."
19588 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19589 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19590 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19592 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19593 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19594 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19595 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19596 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19597 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19599 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19600 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19601 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19602 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19603 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19604 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19605 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19606 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19607 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19613 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19615 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19616 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19617 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19618 .cindex "directory creation"
19619 .cindex "creating directories"
19620 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19621 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19622 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19623 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19624 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19625 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19626 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19627 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19628 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19629 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19631 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19632 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19633 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19636 .cindex "quota" "system"
19637 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19638 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19639 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19641 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19642 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19643 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19644 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19646 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19647 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19650 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19651 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19652 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19653 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19658 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19659 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19660 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19661 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19662 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19664 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19665 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19666 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19667 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19668 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19669 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19670 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19671 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19672 operation. There are two cases:
19675 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19676 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19677 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19678 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19679 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19680 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19681 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19683 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19684 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19685 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19689 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19690 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19691 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19692 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19697 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19699 require "fileinto";
19700 fileinto "folder23";
19702 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19703 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19704 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19705 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19706 way of handling this requirement:
19708 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19709 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19710 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19712 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19716 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19717 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19718 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19720 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19721 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19722 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19723 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19724 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19725 path to the transport.
19727 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19728 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19733 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19734 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19738 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19739 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19740 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19741 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19742 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19743 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19744 delivery is deferred.
19747 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19748 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19749 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19750 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19751 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19752 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19753 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19754 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19757 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19758 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19759 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19760 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19764 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19765 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19768 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19769 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19770 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19771 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19772 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19775 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19776 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19777 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19778 process is running.
19781 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19782 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19783 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19784 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19785 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19786 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19787 contains is significant.
19789 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19790 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19791 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19792 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19793 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19795 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19796 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19797 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19798 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19799 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19800 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19802 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19803 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19804 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19805 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19807 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19808 .cindex "directory creation"
19809 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19810 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19811 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19813 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19814 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19815 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19816 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19817 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19821 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19822 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19823 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19824 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19825 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19828 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19829 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19830 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19831 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19832 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19833 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19834 &%file_must_exist%&.
19837 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19838 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19839 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19840 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19842 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19843 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19844 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19845 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19846 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19849 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19851 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19852 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19853 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19854 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19856 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19858 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19859 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19863 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19864 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19865 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19868 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19869 See &%check_string%& above.
19872 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19873 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19874 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19875 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19876 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19877 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19880 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19881 .cindex "locking files"
19882 .cindex "lock files"
19883 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19884 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19886 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19887 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19890 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19891 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19894 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19895 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19896 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19897 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19898 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19899 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19903 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19904 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19905 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19906 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19907 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19908 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19909 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19910 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19911 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19914 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19915 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19917 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19918 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19919 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19920 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19921 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19922 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19923 delivery is deferred.
19926 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19927 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19928 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19929 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19932 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19933 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19934 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19935 .cindex "locking files"
19936 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19937 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19938 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19939 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19940 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19941 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19942 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19943 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19945 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19946 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19947 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19948 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19950 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19951 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19954 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19956 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19957 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19958 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19960 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19961 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19963 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19966 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19967 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19968 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19969 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19972 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19973 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19974 for details of locking.
19977 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19978 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19979 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19982 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19983 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19984 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19987 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19988 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19989 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19990 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19991 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19994 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19995 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19996 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19997 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19998 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19999 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20000 external source that maintains the data.
20003 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20004 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20005 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20006 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20007 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20008 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20009 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20010 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20014 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20015 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20016 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20017 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20018 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20019 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20020 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20021 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20022 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20023 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20026 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20027 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20028 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20029 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20030 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20031 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20032 calculation. The default value is:
20034 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20036 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20037 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20039 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20041 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20043 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20044 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20045 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20046 directly into that directory.
20049 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20050 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20051 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20054 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20055 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20056 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20060 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20061 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20062 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20063 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20064 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20065 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20066 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20067 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20070 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20071 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20072 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20073 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20074 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20075 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20076 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20077 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20078 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20079 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20082 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20083 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20084 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20085 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20086 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20087 below for further details.
20090 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20091 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20092 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20095 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20096 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20097 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20100 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20101 .cindex "locking files"
20102 .cindex "file" "locking"
20103 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20104 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20105 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20106 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20107 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20108 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20109 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20111 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20112 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20113 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20120 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20121 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20122 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20123 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20124 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20125 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20126 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20127 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20129 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20130 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20131 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20132 append messages to it.
20135 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20136 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20137 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20138 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20139 in which case it is:
20141 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20142 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20144 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20145 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20147 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20148 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20149 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20150 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20155 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20156 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20158 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20159 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20160 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20161 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20162 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20163 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20164 value, and this option is ignored.
20167 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20168 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20169 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20170 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20171 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20174 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20175 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20176 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20177 on users about incoming mail.
20180 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20181 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20182 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20183 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20184 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20185 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20186 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20187 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20188 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20190 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20191 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20192 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20194 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20195 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20196 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20197 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20198 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20199 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20201 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20202 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20203 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20204 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20207 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20209 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20210 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20211 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20212 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20213 system quota failures.
20215 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20216 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20217 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20218 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20219 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20220 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20221 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20222 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20223 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20224 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20227 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20228 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20229 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20230 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20231 delivery directory.
20234 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20235 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20236 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20237 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20238 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20242 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20243 See &%quota%& above.
20246 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20247 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20248 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20249 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20250 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20251 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20252 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20254 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20255 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20256 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20257 the file length to the file name. For example:
20259 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20260 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20262 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20263 number of lines in the message.
20265 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20266 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20267 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20269 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20272 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20273 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20274 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20276 quota_warn_message = "\
20277 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20278 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20279 This message is automatically created \
20280 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20281 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20282 a warning threshold that is\n\
20283 set by the system administrator.\n"
20287 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20288 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20289 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20290 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20291 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20292 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20293 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20294 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20295 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20299 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20301 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20302 percent sign is ignored.
20304 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20305 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20306 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20307 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20308 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20309 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20311 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20313 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20314 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20317 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20318 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20322 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20323 .cindex "envelope sender"
20324 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20325 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20326 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20327 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20328 for details of batch SMTP.
20331 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20332 .cindex "carriage return"
20334 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20335 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20336 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20337 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20339 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20340 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20341 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20342 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20343 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20344 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20347 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20348 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20349 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20350 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20351 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20352 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20355 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20356 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20357 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20358 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20359 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20361 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20362 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20363 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20364 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20366 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20367 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20368 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20369 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20370 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20373 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20374 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20377 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20378 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20379 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20380 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20381 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20382 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20383 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20385 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20386 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20387 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20388 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20391 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20392 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20393 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20396 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20397 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20398 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20399 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20400 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20401 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20402 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20403 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20404 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20406 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20407 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20408 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20409 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20414 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20415 .cindex "appending to a file"
20416 .cindex "file" "appending"
20417 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20420 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20424 .cindex "directory creation"
20425 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20426 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20427 &%directory_mode%& option.
20430 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20431 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20435 .cindex "file" "locking"
20436 .cindex "locking files"
20437 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20438 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20439 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20442 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20443 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20444 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20446 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20448 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20449 Unlink the hitching post name.
20451 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20452 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20453 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20454 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20456 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20457 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20458 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20459 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20460 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20461 it before trying again.
20465 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20466 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20467 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20470 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20471 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20472 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20473 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20474 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20475 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20476 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20477 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20478 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20482 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20483 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20484 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20485 delivery is deferred.
20488 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20489 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20490 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20494 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20495 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20496 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20499 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20500 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20501 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20504 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20505 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20506 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20507 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20508 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20509 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20510 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20511 that prevents link following.
20514 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20515 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20516 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20517 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20518 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20521 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20524 .cindex "file" "locking"
20525 .cindex "locking files"
20526 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20527 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20528 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20529 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20530 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20532 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20534 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20535 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20536 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20538 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20539 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20540 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20542 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20543 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20544 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20545 delivery is deferred.
20547 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20548 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20549 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20550 immediately. It retries up to
20552 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20554 times (rounded up).
20557 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20558 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20561 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20562 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20563 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20564 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20565 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20566 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20567 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20568 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20569 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20570 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20572 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20573 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20574 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20575 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20576 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20577 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20578 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20580 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20581 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20582 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20583 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20586 .cindex "maildir format"
20587 .cindex "mailstore format"
20588 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20589 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20590 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20591 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20592 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20594 .cindex "directory creation"
20595 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20596 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20597 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20598 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20599 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20600 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20605 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20606 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20607 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20608 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20609 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20610 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20611 &_new_& subdirectory.
20613 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20614 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20615 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20616 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20617 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20618 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20619 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20621 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20622 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20623 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20624 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20625 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20626 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20627 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20628 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20630 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20631 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20632 folders. Consider this example:
20634 maildir_format = true
20635 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20636 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20637 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20638 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20640 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20641 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20642 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20643 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20644 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20645 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20647 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20648 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20649 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20650 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20651 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20653 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20654 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20655 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20657 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20658 .cindex "maildir++"
20659 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20660 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20661 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20662 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20663 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20664 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20665 amount of space used.
20667 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20668 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20669 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20670 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20671 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20672 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20677 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20678 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20679 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20680 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20681 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20682 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20685 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20686 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20687 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20688 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20689 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20690 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20691 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20692 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20693 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20694 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
20695 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
20696 backwards compatibility).
20698 For one common implementation, you might set:
20700 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
20702 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
20704 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
20705 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
20706 &[stat()]& each message file.
20709 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20710 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20711 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20712 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20713 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20714 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20715 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20716 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20717 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20719 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20720 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20721 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20722 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20723 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20724 need to know the quota.
20726 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20727 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20729 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20730 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20731 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20735 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20736 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20737 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20738 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20739 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20740 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20741 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20742 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20744 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20745 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20746 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20747 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20748 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20749 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20751 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20752 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20753 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20754 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20755 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20756 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20758 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20759 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20760 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20761 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20764 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20765 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20766 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20767 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20768 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20770 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20772 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20773 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20774 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20775 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20776 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20786 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20787 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20788 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20789 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20790 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20791 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20792 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20793 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20795 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20796 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20797 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20798 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20799 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20802 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20803 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20804 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20805 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20806 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20808 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20809 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20810 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20811 transport is run as a consequence of a
20813 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20814 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20815 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20816 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20817 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20818 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20820 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20821 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20822 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20823 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20825 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20826 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20827 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20828 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20829 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20830 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20831 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20833 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20834 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20835 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20836 the transport defers.
20837 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20838 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20840 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20841 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20842 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20843 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20845 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20846 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20847 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20848 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20849 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20850 problems. They are just discarded.
20854 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20855 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20857 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20858 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20859 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20862 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20863 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20864 when the message is specified by the transport.
20867 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20868 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20869 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20870 string comes first.
20873 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20874 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20875 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20878 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20879 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20880 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20883 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20884 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20885 specified by the transport.
20888 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20889 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20890 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20891 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20894 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20895 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20896 the message is specified by the transport.
20899 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20900 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20904 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20905 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20906 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20907 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20908 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20912 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20913 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20914 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20915 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20917 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20918 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20919 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20920 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20921 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20922 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20923 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20926 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20927 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20928 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20929 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20930 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20932 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20933 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20934 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20935 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20936 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20937 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20940 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20941 See &%once%& above.
20944 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20945 See &%once%& above.
20946 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20949 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20950 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20951 specified by the transport.
20954 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20955 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20956 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20957 configuration option.
20960 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20961 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20962 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20963 automatic responses. For example:
20965 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20967 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20968 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20969 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20970 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20975 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20976 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20977 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20978 the text comes first.
20981 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20982 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20983 when the message is specified by the transport.
20984 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20985 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20993 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20994 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20995 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20996 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20997 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20998 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21000 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21001 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21002 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21003 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21004 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21005 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21009 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21010 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21011 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21014 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21015 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21018 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21019 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21020 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21021 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21022 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21025 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21026 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21027 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21028 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21029 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21030 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21033 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21034 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21035 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21036 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21037 in its response to the LHLO command.
21039 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21040 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21041 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21042 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21045 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21046 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21047 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21048 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21053 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21057 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21058 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21065 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21066 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21067 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21068 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21069 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21070 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21071 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21072 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21076 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21077 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21078 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21079 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21080 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21082 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21083 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21084 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21085 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21086 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21087 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21088 that are routed to the transport.
21090 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21091 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21092 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21093 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21094 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21095 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21096 the local part that was redirected.
21100 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21101 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21102 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21104 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21105 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21106 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21107 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21108 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21109 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21110 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21113 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21114 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21115 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21116 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21117 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21122 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21123 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21124 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21125 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21126 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21127 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21128 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21129 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21130 &"local delivery failed"&.
21132 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21133 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21134 will be sent as normal.
21136 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21137 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21138 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21139 apply in this case.
21141 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21142 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21143 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21144 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21146 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21147 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21148 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21149 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21150 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21151 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21152 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21157 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21158 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21159 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21160 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21161 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21164 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21165 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21166 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21167 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21169 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21170 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21171 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21172 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21173 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21175 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21177 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21178 arguments. You have to write
21180 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21182 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21183 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21184 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21185 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21186 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21187 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21190 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21193 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21194 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21195 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21196 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21197 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21198 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21199 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21200 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21201 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21202 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21204 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21205 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21206 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21207 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21208 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21209 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21210 control what is done with it.
21212 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21213 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21214 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21215 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21216 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21217 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21218 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21219 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21220 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21221 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21222 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21226 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21227 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21228 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21229 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21230 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21231 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21234 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21235 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21236 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21237 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21238 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21239 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21240 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21241 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21242 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21243 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21244 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21245 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21246 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21247 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21248 &`USER `& see below
21250 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21251 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21252 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21253 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21254 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21255 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21256 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21259 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21260 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21261 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21265 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21266 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21267 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21268 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21271 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21272 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21276 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21277 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21278 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21279 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21280 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21281 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21282 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21283 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21284 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21285 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21286 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21289 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21291 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21292 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21293 &%use_shell%& is set.
21296 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21297 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21300 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21301 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21302 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21305 .option check_string pipe string unset
21306 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21307 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21308 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21309 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21310 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21311 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21312 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21316 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21317 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21318 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21319 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21320 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21321 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21322 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21325 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21326 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21327 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21328 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21329 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21330 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21331 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21334 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21335 See &%check_string%& above.
21338 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21339 .cindex "exec failure"
21340 .cindex "failure of exec"
21341 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21342 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21343 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21344 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21345 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21348 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21349 .cindex "signal exit"
21350 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21351 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21352 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21353 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21356 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21357 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21358 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21359 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21360 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21361 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21363 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21364 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21366 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21367 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21368 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21369 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21370 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21373 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21374 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21375 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21376 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21377 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21378 Only one of them may be set.
21382 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21383 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21384 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21385 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21389 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21390 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21391 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21392 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21393 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21394 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21395 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21396 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21399 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21400 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21401 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21404 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21408 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21409 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21410 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21411 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21412 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21417 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21418 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21421 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21422 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21423 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21424 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21428 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21429 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21432 .option path pipe string "see below"
21433 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21434 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21438 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21439 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21440 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21443 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21444 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21445 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21446 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21447 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21448 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21449 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21450 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21451 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21454 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21455 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21456 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21457 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21458 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21459 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21460 accept the message is used.
21463 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21464 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21465 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21466 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21467 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21468 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21471 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21472 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21473 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21474 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21475 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21476 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21477 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21481 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21482 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21483 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21484 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21485 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21486 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21487 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21488 of them may be set.
21492 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21493 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21494 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21495 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21496 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21497 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21498 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21499 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21500 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21501 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21502 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21503 and 73, respectively.
21506 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21507 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21508 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21509 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21510 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21511 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21512 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21514 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21515 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21516 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21517 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21518 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21519 delivery to be deferred.
21521 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21522 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21525 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21526 .cindex "envelope sender"
21527 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21528 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21529 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21530 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21531 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21533 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21534 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21535 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21536 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21537 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21538 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21542 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21543 .cindex "carriage return"
21545 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21546 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21547 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21548 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21550 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21551 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21552 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21553 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21554 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21557 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21558 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21559 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21560 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21561 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21562 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21563 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21564 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21565 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21570 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21571 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21572 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21573 .cindex "external local delivery"
21574 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21575 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21576 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21577 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21578 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21579 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21580 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21581 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21582 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21583 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21588 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21592 check_string = "From "
21593 escape_string = ">From "
21602 transport = procmail_pipe
21604 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21605 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21606 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21607 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21608 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21609 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21611 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21615 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21616 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21619 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21620 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21623 local_delivery_cyrus:
21625 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21626 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21638 local_part_suffix = .*
21639 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21641 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21642 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21644 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21645 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21651 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21652 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21653 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21654 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21655 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21656 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21657 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21658 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21661 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21662 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21666 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21667 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21668 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21669 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21670 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21671 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21672 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21674 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21675 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21676 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21677 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21678 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21679 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21684 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21685 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21686 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21690 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21692 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21693 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21694 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21695 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21696 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21697 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21698 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21699 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21702 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21703 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21704 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21705 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21706 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21707 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21708 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21709 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21710 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21711 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21712 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21715 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21716 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21717 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21720 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21721 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21722 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21723 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21724 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21725 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21726 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21727 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21729 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21730 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21731 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21732 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21733 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21734 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21735 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21736 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21737 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21740 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21742 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21743 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21744 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21745 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21746 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21749 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21750 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21751 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21752 particular connection.
21754 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21755 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21756 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21757 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21759 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21760 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21761 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21763 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21765 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21766 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21768 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21769 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21773 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21774 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21775 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21776 authenticated as a client.
21779 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21780 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21781 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21782 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21785 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21786 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21787 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21788 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21789 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21790 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21791 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21794 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21795 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21796 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21797 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21798 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21799 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21800 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21804 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21805 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21806 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21807 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21810 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21811 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21812 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21815 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21816 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21817 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21818 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21819 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21820 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21822 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21823 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21824 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21825 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21826 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21827 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21828 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21829 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21833 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21834 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21835 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21836 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21837 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21840 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21841 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21842 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21843 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21848 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21849 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21850 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21851 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21852 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21853 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21854 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21855 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21857 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21858 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21859 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21860 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21861 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21862 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21864 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21865 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21866 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21867 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21868 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21870 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21871 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21872 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21873 copy of the message is sent.
21875 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21876 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21877 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21878 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21882 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21883 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21884 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21887 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21888 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21889 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21890 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21891 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21892 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21894 .option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21895 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21896 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21898 .option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21899 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21900 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21902 .option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21903 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21904 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21906 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21907 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21908 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21909 implementations of TLS.
21911 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21912 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21913 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21914 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21915 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21916 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21917 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21922 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21923 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21924 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21925 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21926 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21927 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21928 interface address, you could use this:
21930 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21931 {$primary_hostname}}
21933 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21936 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21937 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21938 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21939 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21940 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21941 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21943 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21944 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21945 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21946 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21948 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21949 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21950 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21951 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21952 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21953 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21954 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21956 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21957 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21958 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21959 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21960 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21961 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21962 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21965 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21966 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21969 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21970 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21971 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21972 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21973 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21974 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21975 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21976 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21977 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21978 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21981 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21982 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21983 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21984 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21987 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21988 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21989 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21990 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21993 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21994 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21995 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21996 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21997 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21998 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21999 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22000 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22003 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22004 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22005 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22010 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22011 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22012 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22013 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22014 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22015 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22016 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22017 explanation of when this might be needed.
22020 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22021 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22022 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22023 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22024 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22027 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22028 .cindex "randomized host list"
22029 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22030 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22031 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22032 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22033 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22034 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22035 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22036 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22038 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22039 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22040 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22041 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22043 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22045 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22046 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22047 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22049 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22050 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22051 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22052 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22053 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22054 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22055 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22056 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22057 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22060 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22061 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22062 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22063 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22064 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22065 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22067 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22068 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22069 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22070 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22071 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22072 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22073 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22075 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22076 .cindex "bind IP address"
22077 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22079 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22080 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22081 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22082 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22083 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22084 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22085 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22086 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22089 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22090 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22091 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22092 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22093 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22094 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22096 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22098 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22099 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22100 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22101 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22104 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22105 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22106 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22107 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22108 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22109 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22110 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22111 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22112 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22113 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22117 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22118 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22119 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22120 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22121 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22123 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22124 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22125 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22126 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22127 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22131 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22132 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22133 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22134 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22135 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22136 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22137 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22138 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22141 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22142 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22143 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22144 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22145 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22146 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22147 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22148 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22150 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22151 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22152 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22153 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22158 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22159 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22160 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22161 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22163 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22164 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22165 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22166 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22167 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22170 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22171 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22172 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22173 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22177 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22178 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22179 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22180 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22181 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22182 addresses is not affected.
22184 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22185 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22186 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22187 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22188 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22192 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22193 .cindex "serializing connections"
22194 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22195 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22196 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22197 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22198 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22199 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22200 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22202 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22203 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22204 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22205 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22206 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22207 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22209 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22210 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22211 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22212 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22213 are used for ETRN serialization.
22216 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22217 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22218 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22219 .cindex "size" "of message"
22220 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22221 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22222 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22223 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22224 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22225 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22226 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22227 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22229 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22230 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22233 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22234 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22235 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22237 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22238 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22239 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22240 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22241 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22244 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22245 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22246 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22247 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22251 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22252 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22253 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22254 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22255 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22258 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22259 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22261 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22262 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22263 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22264 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22265 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22266 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22267 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22268 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22271 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22272 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22273 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22275 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22276 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22277 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22278 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22279 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22280 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22281 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22282 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22283 ciphers is a preference order.
22287 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22288 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22289 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22290 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22291 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22292 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22293 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22294 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22295 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22296 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22300 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22301 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22302 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22304 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22305 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22306 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22307 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22308 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22309 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22310 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22311 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22312 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22317 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22319 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22320 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22321 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22322 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22323 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22326 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22327 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22328 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22329 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22332 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22333 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22334 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22336 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22337 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22338 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22339 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22340 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22342 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22343 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22344 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22345 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22346 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22347 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22348 see below for an exception).
22350 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22351 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22352 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22353 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22354 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22356 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22357 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22358 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22359 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22360 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22361 reached their retry times.
22363 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22364 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22365 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22366 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22367 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22368 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22369 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22370 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22371 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22372 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22375 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22376 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22377 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22378 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22379 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22380 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22382 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22383 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22384 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22385 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22386 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22387 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22396 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22397 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22398 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22399 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22400 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22401 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22403 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22404 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22405 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22406 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22407 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22408 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22409 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22411 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22412 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22413 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22414 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22417 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22418 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22419 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22420 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22422 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22423 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22424 facility; you do not have to use it.
22426 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22427 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22428 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22429 address to which it applies.
22431 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22432 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22433 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22434 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22435 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22436 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22439 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22440 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22441 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22442 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22445 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22446 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22447 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22448 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22449 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22452 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22453 illustrated by these examples:
22456 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22457 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22458 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22459 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22461 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22462 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22467 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22468 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22469 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22470 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22471 message's processing.
22473 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22474 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22475 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22476 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22477 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22478 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22479 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22480 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22481 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22483 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22484 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22485 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22486 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22487 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22488 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22489 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22490 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22491 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22492 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22494 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22495 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22496 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22497 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22498 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22499 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22501 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22502 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22503 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22505 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22506 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22507 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22508 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22509 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22510 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22511 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22512 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22513 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22515 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22516 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22522 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22523 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22524 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22525 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22526 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22527 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22528 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22529 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22530 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22531 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22533 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22535 might produce the output
22537 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22538 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22539 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22540 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22541 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22542 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22543 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22544 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22546 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22547 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22548 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22549 set for a particular transport.
22552 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22553 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22554 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22557 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22559 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22560 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22561 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22562 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22564 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22565 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22566 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22567 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22570 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22571 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22572 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22574 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22575 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22576 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22577 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22578 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22579 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22580 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22582 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22583 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22584 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22585 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22586 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22590 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22591 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22594 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22595 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22596 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22597 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22598 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22599 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22600 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22601 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22602 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22604 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22605 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22606 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22608 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22609 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22610 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22611 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22612 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22613 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22614 of pattern they are set as follows:
22617 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22618 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22619 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22622 *queen@*.fict.example
22624 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22626 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22630 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22631 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22634 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22635 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22636 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22637 rewriting rule of the form
22639 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22641 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22647 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22648 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22649 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22650 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22651 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22655 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22656 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22657 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22658 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22659 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22661 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22663 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22666 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22667 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22668 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22669 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22670 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22671 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22672 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22673 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22674 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22675 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22676 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22677 entry written to the panic log.
22681 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22682 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22685 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22688 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22690 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22693 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22694 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22698 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22700 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22701 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22702 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22703 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22704 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22705 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22707 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22708 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22709 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22710 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22711 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22712 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22713 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22714 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22715 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22716 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22718 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22719 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22720 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22722 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22723 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22726 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22727 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22728 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22729 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22730 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22731 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22732 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22733 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22734 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22736 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22737 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22738 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22739 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22740 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22741 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22742 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22743 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22746 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22747 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22748 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22749 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22752 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22753 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22754 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22756 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22757 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22758 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22759 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22761 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22762 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22763 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22765 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22766 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22767 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22768 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22770 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22774 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22777 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22778 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22779 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22780 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22781 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22782 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22783 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22784 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22786 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22787 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22791 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22792 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22794 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22795 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22796 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22798 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22799 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22800 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22801 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22802 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22803 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22804 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22805 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22807 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22808 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22810 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22812 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22813 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22815 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22816 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22817 messages that originate outside the local host:
22819 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22820 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22822 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22825 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22826 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22827 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22828 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22829 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22830 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22831 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22832 components. For example, the rule
22834 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22836 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22837 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22838 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22839 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22840 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22841 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22842 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22852 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22853 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22854 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22855 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22856 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22857 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22858 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22859 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22860 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22861 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22862 address, domain and error.
22864 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22865 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22866 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22867 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22868 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22869 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22870 log selector is set, the message
22871 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22872 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22873 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22874 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22876 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22877 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22878 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22879 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22880 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22881 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22882 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22883 domain are maintained independently.
22885 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22886 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22887 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22888 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22889 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22890 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22891 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22892 the local address is reached.
22894 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22895 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22896 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22897 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22898 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22900 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22901 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22902 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22903 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22904 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22905 messages that it should now be retaining.
22909 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22910 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22911 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22912 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22913 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22914 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22915 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22916 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22917 message's sender, respectively.
22920 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22921 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22922 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22923 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22924 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22925 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22928 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22930 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22933 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22935 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22936 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22939 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22940 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22941 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22942 expressions work in address lists.
22944 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22945 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22949 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22950 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22951 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22952 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22953 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22954 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22955 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22956 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22957 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22959 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22960 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22961 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22962 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22965 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22966 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22967 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22968 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22969 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22970 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22971 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22972 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22973 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22974 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22979 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22981 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22982 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22983 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22984 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22985 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22986 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22988 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22992 and the retry rules are
22994 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22995 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22997 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22998 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22999 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23000 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23001 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23002 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23004 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23005 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23006 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23007 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23009 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23010 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23011 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23013 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23015 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23016 textual form of the IP address.
23018 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23019 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23020 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23021 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23024 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23025 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23026 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23028 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23029 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23030 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23032 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23033 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23035 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23036 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23039 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23040 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23041 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23042 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23043 retry rule of this form:
23045 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23047 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23048 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23051 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23052 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23053 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23054 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23056 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23057 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23059 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23060 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23063 A connection was refused.
23065 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23066 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23068 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23069 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23071 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23072 A connection attempt timed out.
23074 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23075 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23076 obtained from an MX record.
23078 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23079 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23080 obtained from an MX record.
23083 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23085 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23086 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23087 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23088 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23091 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23094 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23095 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23096 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23097 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23098 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23099 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23103 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23104 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23105 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23106 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23107 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23111 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23112 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23113 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23115 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23116 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23117 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23118 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23119 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23120 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23121 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23123 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23124 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23127 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23128 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23129 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23134 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23135 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23136 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23137 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23138 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23141 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23143 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23145 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23147 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23148 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23151 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23153 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23154 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23155 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23156 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23157 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23159 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23160 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23162 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23164 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23165 list is never matched.
23171 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23172 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23173 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23174 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23176 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23178 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23179 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23180 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23181 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23182 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23184 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23185 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23186 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23187 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23188 The available algorithms are:
23191 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23194 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23195 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23196 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23198 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23199 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23200 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23201 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23202 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23203 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23204 queue processing times.
23207 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23208 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23209 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23210 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23211 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23212 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23213 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23214 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23215 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23216 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23217 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23218 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23220 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23221 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23222 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23223 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23224 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23225 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23228 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23229 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23230 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23231 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23232 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23233 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23234 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23235 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23236 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23237 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23238 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23239 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23241 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23242 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23243 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23244 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23245 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23246 deliveries that have been deferred.
23249 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23250 Here are some example retry rules:
23252 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23253 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23254 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23255 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23256 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23257 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23259 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23260 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23261 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23262 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23263 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23264 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23265 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23268 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23269 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23270 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23271 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23272 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23274 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23275 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23276 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23277 were not obtained from an MX record.
23279 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23280 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23281 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23282 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23283 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23287 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23288 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23289 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23290 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23291 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23292 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23293 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23294 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23295 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23296 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23297 failing for the first time.
23299 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23300 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23301 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23302 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23304 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23305 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23306 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23311 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23312 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23313 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23314 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23315 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23316 default retry rule:
23318 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23320 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23321 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23322 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23324 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23325 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23326 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23327 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23328 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23330 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23331 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23332 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23334 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23335 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23336 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23337 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23338 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23339 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23340 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23341 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23343 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23344 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23345 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23346 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23347 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23350 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23351 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23352 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23353 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23354 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23355 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23356 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23357 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23358 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23361 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23362 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23363 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23364 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23365 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23366 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23367 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23368 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23371 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23372 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23373 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23374 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23375 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23376 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23377 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23378 time out the address.
23380 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23381 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23382 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23383 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23384 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23385 considered immediately.
23386 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23387 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23397 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23398 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23399 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23400 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23401 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23402 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23403 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23404 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23405 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23408 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23409 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23412 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23413 the client's EHLO command.
23415 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23416 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23418 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23419 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23420 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23421 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23422 with the AUTH command.
23424 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23426 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23427 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23428 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23431 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23432 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23433 unauthenticated connection.
23436 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23437 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23438 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23439 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23441 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23442 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23443 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23444 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23445 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23446 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23447 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23448 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23453 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23454 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23455 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23456 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23457 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23458 included by setting
23461 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23465 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23470 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23471 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23472 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23474 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23475 work via a socket interface.
23476 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23477 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23478 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23479 supporting setting a server keytab.
23480 The sixth can be configured to support
23481 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23482 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23483 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23486 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23487 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23488 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23489 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23490 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23491 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23492 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23494 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23495 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23496 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23497 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23498 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23499 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23503 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23504 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23506 client_secret = secret2
23508 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23509 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23511 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23512 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23513 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23517 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23518 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23519 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23520 authenticating data.
23522 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23523 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23524 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23525 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23526 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23527 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23528 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23529 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23530 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23531 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23534 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23535 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23536 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23537 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23542 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23543 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23544 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23546 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23547 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23548 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23549 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23550 encrypted by a setting such as:
23552 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23554 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23555 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23556 cipher used for the delivery.)
23559 .option driver authenticators string unset
23560 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23561 authenticators is to be used.
23564 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23565 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23566 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23567 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23568 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23569 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23572 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23573 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23574 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23575 mechanism is not advertised.
23576 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23577 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23578 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23581 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23582 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23583 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23587 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23588 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23591 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23592 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23593 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23594 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23595 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23596 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23597 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23598 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23599 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23603 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23604 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23605 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23606 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23607 out the values of variables.
23608 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23609 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23612 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23613 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23614 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23615 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23616 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23617 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23618 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23619 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23620 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23623 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23624 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23625 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23626 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23627 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23628 remembered for later use.
23629 How it is used is described in the following section.
23635 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23636 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23637 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23638 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23639 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23643 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23644 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23646 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23648 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23649 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23650 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23651 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23652 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23653 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23654 given for the MAIL command.
23656 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23657 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23660 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23661 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23662 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23663 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23664 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23665 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23666 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23671 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23672 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23673 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23674 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23676 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23677 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23678 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23679 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23680 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23685 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23686 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23687 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23688 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23692 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23694 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23695 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23698 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23699 the mechanisms are advertised.
23701 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23702 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23703 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23704 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23705 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23706 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23707 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23709 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23711 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23713 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23714 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23715 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23718 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23720 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23721 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23722 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23724 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23725 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23726 command. This is the case if
23729 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23731 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23733 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23734 server authenticators.
23738 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23739 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23740 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23742 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23743 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23744 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23745 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23746 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23747 rejected with a 504 error.
23749 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23750 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23751 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23752 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23753 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23754 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23755 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23756 no successful authentication.
23761 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23762 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23763 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23764 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23765 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23766 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23767 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23771 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23773 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23774 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23775 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23776 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23777 command line to run this script on such data might be
23779 encode '\0user\0password'
23781 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23782 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23783 whose code value is zero.
23785 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23786 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23787 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23788 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23790 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23791 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23792 example, a command such as
23794 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23796 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23798 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23799 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23801 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23803 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23804 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23805 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23806 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23810 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23811 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23812 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23813 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23814 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23815 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23818 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23819 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23820 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23821 of the authenticator.
23824 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23825 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23826 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23827 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23828 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23829 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23830 delivery to be deferred.
23832 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23833 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23834 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23837 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23838 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23839 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23840 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23841 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23842 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23843 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23844 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23845 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23848 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23849 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23850 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23851 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23852 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23853 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23854 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23855 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23856 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23857 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23858 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23859 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23860 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23868 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23870 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23871 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23872 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23873 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23874 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23875 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23876 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23877 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23878 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23879 connections as you do for login accounts.
23881 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23882 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23883 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23885 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23886 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23887 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23889 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23890 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23891 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23894 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23895 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23896 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23897 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23898 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23899 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23900 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23902 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23903 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23904 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23905 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23906 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23907 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23908 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23910 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23911 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23912 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23913 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23915 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23916 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23917 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23919 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23920 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23921 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23922 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23923 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23924 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23925 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23926 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23927 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23928 string as the error text.
23930 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23931 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23932 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23936 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23937 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23938 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23939 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23940 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23941 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23942 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23943 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23945 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23946 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23947 configured as follows:
23951 public_name = PLAIN
23953 server_condition = \
23954 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23955 server_set_id = $auth2
23957 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23958 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23959 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23960 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23962 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23963 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23964 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23965 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23969 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23971 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23973 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23974 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23978 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23979 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23981 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23982 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23983 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23984 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23985 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23987 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23988 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23989 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23991 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23992 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23993 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23994 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23995 This is an incorrect example:
23997 server_condition = \
23998 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24000 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24001 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24002 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24003 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24004 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24005 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24006 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24008 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24009 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24011 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24012 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24013 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24014 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24015 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24018 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24019 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24020 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24021 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24022 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24023 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24024 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24028 public_name = LOGIN
24029 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24030 server_condition = \
24031 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24032 server_set_id = $auth1
24034 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24035 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24036 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24037 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24039 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24040 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24041 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24042 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24043 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24047 public_name = LOGIN
24048 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24049 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24051 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24052 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24053 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24054 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24056 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24057 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24058 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24059 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24060 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24061 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24062 uninterpreted string.
24065 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24066 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24067 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24068 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24069 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24075 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24076 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24077 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24079 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24080 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24081 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24082 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24085 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24086 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24087 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24088 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24089 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24090 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24091 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24092 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24093 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24094 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24095 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24096 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24098 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24099 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24101 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24102 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24103 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24104 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24107 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24108 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24112 public_name = PLAIN
24113 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24115 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24116 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24117 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24121 public_name = LOGIN
24122 client_send = : username : mysecret
24124 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24125 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24127 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24128 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24136 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24137 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24138 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24139 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24140 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24141 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24142 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24143 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24144 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24145 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24146 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24147 available in plain text at either end.
24150 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24151 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24152 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24153 authenticator as a server:
24155 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24156 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24157 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24158 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24159 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24160 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24161 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24162 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24163 returned to the client.
24165 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24166 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24167 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24168 numeric variables for other things.
24170 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24171 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24172 user name, authentication fails.
24176 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24177 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24178 server_set_id = $auth1
24180 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24181 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24182 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24183 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24187 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24188 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24190 server_set_id = $auth1
24192 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24193 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24196 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24197 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24198 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24203 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24204 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24205 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24206 server_set_id = $auth1
24210 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24211 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24212 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24216 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24217 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24218 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24221 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24222 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24223 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24227 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24228 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24229 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24230 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24231 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24232 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24233 send the message to the current server.
24235 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24240 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24242 client_secret = secret
24244 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24245 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24252 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24253 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24254 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24255 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24257 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24258 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24260 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24261 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24262 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24263 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24264 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24266 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24267 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24268 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24269 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24271 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24272 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24273 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24274 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24275 depending on the driver you are using.
24277 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24278 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24279 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24280 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24281 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24284 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24285 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24286 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24287 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24288 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24289 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24290 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24291 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24295 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24296 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24297 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24298 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24299 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24300 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24304 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24305 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24306 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24307 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24310 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24311 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24312 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24313 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24317 driver = cyrus_sasl
24318 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24319 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24320 server_set_id = $auth1
24324 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24325 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24329 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24330 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24333 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24334 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24335 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24336 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24339 driver = cyrus_sasl
24340 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24341 server_set_id = $auth1
24344 driver = cyrus_sasl
24345 public_name = PLAIN
24346 server_set_id = $auth2
24348 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24349 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24350 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24351 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24352 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24359 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24360 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24361 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24362 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24363 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24364 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24365 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24366 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24368 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24370 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24371 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24372 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24373 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24377 public_name = PLAIN
24378 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24379 server_set_id = $auth2
24384 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24385 server_set_id = $auth1
24387 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24388 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24389 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24390 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24391 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24392 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24393 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24394 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24400 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24401 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24402 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24403 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24404 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24405 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24406 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24407 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24408 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24409 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24410 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24411 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24412 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24413 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.78 release
24414 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24415 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24416 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24417 without code changes in Exim.
24420 .option server_channelbinding gsasl bool false
24421 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24422 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24423 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24424 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24427 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24428 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24429 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24431 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24432 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24433 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24435 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24436 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24437 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24440 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24441 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24442 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24443 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24446 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24447 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24448 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24449 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24454 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24455 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24456 server_set_id = $auth1
24460 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24461 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24462 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24463 the password itself.
24465 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24466 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24467 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24468 if available, else the empty string.
24469 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24470 else the empty string.
24472 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24474 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24475 option to be simply "true".
24478 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24479 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24480 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24483 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24484 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24485 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24486 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24489 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24490 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24491 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24492 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24495 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24496 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24497 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24500 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24501 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24502 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24503 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24505 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24506 meanings for these variables:
24509 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24510 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24512 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24513 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24515 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24516 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24519 On a per-mechanism basis:
24522 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24523 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24524 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24526 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24527 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24528 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24530 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24531 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24532 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24533 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24536 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24537 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24538 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24541 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24542 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24544 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24546 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24547 server_realm = imap.example.org
24548 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24549 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24550 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24551 server_condition = yes
24556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24560 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24561 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24562 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24563 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24564 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24565 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24566 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24569 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24570 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24571 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24572 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24574 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24575 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24576 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24577 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24579 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24580 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24581 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24585 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24586 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24587 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24588 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24590 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24591 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24592 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24593 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24595 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24597 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24598 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24600 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24601 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
24602 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
24608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24611 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24612 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24613 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24614 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24615 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24616 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24617 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24618 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24619 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24620 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24621 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24622 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24623 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24627 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24628 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24630 The server sends back a challenge.
24632 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24633 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24636 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24640 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24641 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24642 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24644 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24645 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24646 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24647 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24648 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24649 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24650 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24651 for other things. For example:
24656 server_password = \
24657 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24659 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24660 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24666 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24667 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24668 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24672 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24673 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24676 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24677 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24680 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24681 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24682 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24688 client_username = msn/msn_username
24689 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24690 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24692 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24693 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24702 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24703 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24704 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24705 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24706 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24709 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24710 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24711 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24712 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24713 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24714 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24715 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24716 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24717 certificates are used.
24719 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24720 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24721 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24722 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24723 between them is encrypted.
24725 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24726 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24727 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24728 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24731 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24732 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24733 in order to get TLS to work.
24737 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24739 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24740 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24741 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24742 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24743 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24744 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24745 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24746 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24747 allocated for this purpose.
24749 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24750 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24751 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24752 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24754 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24756 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24757 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24758 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24759 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24760 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24763 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24764 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24771 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24772 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24773 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24774 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24775 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24779 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24783 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24784 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24786 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24789 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24790 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24792 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24793 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24794 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24796 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24797 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24798 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24799 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24801 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24802 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24803 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24804 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24805 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24806 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24809 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24810 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24814 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24815 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24816 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24817 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24818 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24819 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24820 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24821 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24822 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24823 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24824 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24826 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24827 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24828 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24829 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24830 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24831 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24832 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24833 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24835 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24836 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24837 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24839 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24840 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24841 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24842 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24846 # chown exim:exim new-params
24847 # chmod 0400 new-params
24848 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24849 # echo "" >>new-params
24850 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24851 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24853 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24854 stalling is removed.
24857 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24858 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24859 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24860 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24861 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24862 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24863 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24864 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24865 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24868 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24870 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24871 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24872 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24875 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24876 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24877 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24881 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24884 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24885 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24888 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24889 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24891 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24892 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24895 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24896 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24897 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24898 not be moved to the end of the list.
24903 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24905 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24906 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24907 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24908 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24909 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24910 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24911 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24912 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24913 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24914 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24915 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24916 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24917 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24918 passed to its control function.
24920 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24921 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24922 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24923 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24924 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24925 the same as if just AES were given.
24927 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24928 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24929 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24930 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24931 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24932 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24933 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24935 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24936 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24937 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24938 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24939 can be changed in the usual way.
24941 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24942 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24943 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24944 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24945 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24947 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24948 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24949 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24950 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24952 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24954 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24956 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24958 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24960 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24961 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24962 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24963 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24965 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24966 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24967 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24969 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24970 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24973 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1.2, TLS1.1,
24974 TLS1.0, (TLS1) and SSL3.
24975 The default list contains TLS1.2, TLS1.1, TLS1.0, SSL3.
24976 TLS1 is an alias for TLS1.0, for backwards compatibility.
24977 For sufficiently old versions of the GnuTLS library, TLS1.2 or TLS1.1 might
24978 not be supported and will not be recognised by Exim.
24981 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24982 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24983 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24984 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24985 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24990 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24991 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24992 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24993 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24994 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24995 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24996 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24997 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24999 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25000 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25001 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25004 554 Security failure
25006 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25007 rejected with a 554 error code.
25009 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25010 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25011 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25012 without some further configuration at the server end.
25014 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25015 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25017 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25018 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25020 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25021 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25022 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25023 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25024 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25025 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25026 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25027 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25028 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25029 the server's certificate.
25031 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25032 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25033 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25035 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25036 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25037 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25040 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25041 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25042 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25044 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25046 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25047 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
25048 suites that the server supports. See the command
25052 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
25053 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
25055 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25056 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25057 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25058 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25059 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25061 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25062 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25063 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
25064 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25065 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25066 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25067 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25068 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25069 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25070 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
25073 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25074 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25075 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25076 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25077 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25078 documentation for more details.
25081 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25082 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25083 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25084 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25085 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25086 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25087 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25088 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25089 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25090 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25091 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25092 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25094 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25097 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25098 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25099 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25101 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25103 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25105 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25106 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25107 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25108 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25109 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25110 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25111 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25112 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25113 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25114 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25116 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25117 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25118 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25119 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25121 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25122 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25123 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25124 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25125 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25126 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
25129 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25130 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25131 .cindex "revocation list"
25132 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25133 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25134 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25135 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25136 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25137 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25141 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25142 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25143 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25144 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25145 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25146 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25147 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25148 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25149 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25151 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25152 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25153 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25154 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25155 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25157 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25158 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25159 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25160 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25161 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25164 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25165 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25166 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25167 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25168 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25169 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25170 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25171 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25172 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25173 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25176 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25177 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25178 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25179 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25181 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25182 must name a file or,
25183 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25184 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25185 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25186 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25189 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25190 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25191 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25192 alternative hosts, if any.
25195 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25196 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25197 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25201 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25202 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25203 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25204 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25205 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25207 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25208 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25209 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
25210 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25211 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25212 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25213 outgoing connection.
25217 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25219 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25220 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25221 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25222 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25223 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25224 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25225 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25226 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25227 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25228 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25229 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25231 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25232 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25233 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25234 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25235 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25236 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25237 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25238 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25239 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25241 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25242 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25243 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25244 information is recorded.
25246 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25247 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25248 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25253 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25254 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25255 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25256 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25257 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25258 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25259 to Apache, currently at
25261 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25263 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25264 links to further files.
25265 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25266 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25267 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25269 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25273 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25274 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25275 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25276 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25277 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25278 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25279 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25280 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25281 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25282 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25283 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25284 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25285 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25288 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25289 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25290 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25291 with OpenSSL, like this:
25293 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25296 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25297 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25298 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25299 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25300 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25301 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25302 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25304 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25305 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25306 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25308 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25309 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25310 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25311 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25312 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25313 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25315 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25316 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25317 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25318 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25319 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25320 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25327 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25328 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25329 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25330 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25331 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25332 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25333 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25334 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25335 one very small ACL:
25339 accept hosts = one.host.only
25341 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25342 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25344 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25345 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25346 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25347 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25348 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25349 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25350 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25351 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25354 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25355 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25356 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25357 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25358 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25362 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25363 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25364 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25365 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25366 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25367 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25368 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25369 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25370 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25371 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25372 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25373 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25374 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25375 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25376 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25377 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25378 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25379 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25382 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25383 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25384 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25385 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25386 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25387 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25388 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25389 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25390 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25391 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25392 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25393 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25394 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25395 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25396 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25397 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25398 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25399 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25402 For example, if you set
25404 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25406 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25407 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25408 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25409 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25410 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25411 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25412 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25415 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25416 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25417 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25418 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25419 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25420 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25421 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25422 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25423 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25424 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25425 in any of these ACLs.
25427 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25428 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25429 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25430 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25431 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25432 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25433 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25434 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25436 control = suppress_local_fixups
25438 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25439 run, it is too late.
25441 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25442 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25444 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25445 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25446 temporary error for these kinds of message.
25449 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25450 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25451 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25452 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25453 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25454 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25455 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25456 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25457 &%smtp_banner%& option.
25460 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25461 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25462 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25463 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25464 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25465 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25466 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25467 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25468 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25470 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25471 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25472 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25473 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25477 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25478 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25479 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25480 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25481 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25482 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25483 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25484 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25485 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25486 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25488 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25489 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25490 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25491 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25492 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25493 associated with the DATA command.
25495 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25496 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25497 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25498 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25499 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25503 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25504 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25505 enabled (which is the default).
25507 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25508 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25509 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25511 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25514 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25515 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25516 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25519 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25520 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25521 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25522 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25523 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25524 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25526 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25527 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25528 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25529 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25531 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25532 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25534 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25535 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25538 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25539 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25540 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25541 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25542 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25545 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25546 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25547 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25548 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25549 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25550 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25551 situation even worse.
25553 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25554 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25555 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25558 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
25559 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
25560 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
25561 connection. The possible values are:
25563 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
25564 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
25565 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
25566 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
25567 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
25568 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
25569 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
25570 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
25571 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
25572 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
25574 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
25575 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
25576 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
25577 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
25578 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
25582 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
25583 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
25584 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
25585 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
25587 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
25588 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
25590 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
25591 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
25592 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
25593 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25594 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25596 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25597 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25598 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25601 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25602 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25603 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25604 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25605 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25606 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25608 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25609 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25610 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25612 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25613 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25614 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25615 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25617 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25618 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25619 matches the string.
25621 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25622 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25623 want to have something like
25625 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25627 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25628 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25634 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25635 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25636 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25637 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25638 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25639 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25640 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25641 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25642 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25644 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25645 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25646 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25649 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25650 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25651 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25652 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25654 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25655 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25656 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25657 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25658 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25659 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25660 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25663 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25664 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25665 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25669 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25670 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25671 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25672 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25673 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25674 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25676 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25677 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25678 used to accept or reject anything.
25680 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25681 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25682 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25683 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25685 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25686 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25687 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25688 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25689 configuration file.
25694 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25695 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25697 .vindex &$local_part$&
25698 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25699 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25700 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25701 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25702 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25703 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25704 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25705 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25706 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25708 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25709 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25710 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25713 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25714 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25715 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25716 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25717 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25720 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25721 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25722 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25723 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25724 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25725 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25726 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25727 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25733 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25734 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25735 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25736 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25737 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25738 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25739 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25740 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25741 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25742 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25743 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25744 unencrypted connections.
25747 accept encrypted = *
25748 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25750 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25752 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25753 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25754 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25755 option to do this.)
25759 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25760 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25761 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25762 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25763 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25764 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25765 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25767 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25768 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25769 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25772 deny dnslists = list1.example
25773 dnslists = list2.example
25775 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25776 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25777 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25778 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25779 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25782 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25783 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25786 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25787 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25788 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25789 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25790 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25791 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25792 check a RCPT command:
25794 accept domains = +local_domains
25798 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25799 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25800 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25801 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25804 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25805 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25806 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25809 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25810 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25811 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25812 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25813 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25814 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25816 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25817 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25819 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25820 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25821 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25823 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25824 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25825 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25830 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25831 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25832 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25833 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25834 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25835 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25836 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25840 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25841 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25842 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25845 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25847 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25851 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25852 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25853 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25854 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25855 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25856 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25857 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25858 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25859 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25861 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25862 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25863 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25867 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25868 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25869 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25871 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25872 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25874 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25875 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25878 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25879 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25880 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25881 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25883 require message = Sender did not verify
25886 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25887 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25888 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25889 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25892 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25893 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25894 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25895 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25896 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25897 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25898 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25900 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25901 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25902 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25903 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25904 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25906 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25907 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25908 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25909 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25910 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25911 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25915 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25916 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25917 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25918 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25920 warn !verify = sender
25921 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25925 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25927 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25928 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25929 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25930 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25931 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25935 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25936 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25937 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25938 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25939 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25940 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25941 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25942 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25943 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25944 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25946 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25947 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25948 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25949 on the same SMTP connection.
25951 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25952 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25953 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25956 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25957 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25958 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25960 accept hosts = whatever
25961 set acl_m4 = some value
25962 accept authenticated = *
25963 set acl_c_auth = yes
25965 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25966 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25967 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25969 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25970 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25971 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25972 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25973 error is generated.
25975 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25976 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25979 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25980 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25981 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25982 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25984 deny domains = *.dom.example
25985 !verify = recipient
25987 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25988 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25989 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25990 two statements are equivalent:
25992 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25993 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25995 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25996 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25998 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25999 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26000 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26002 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26003 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26004 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26005 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26007 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26008 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26009 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26010 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26011 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26012 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26013 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26015 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26016 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26017 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26018 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26019 message is handled.
26021 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26022 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26023 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26024 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26026 require message = Can't verify sender
26028 message = Can't verify recipient
26030 message = This message cannot be used
26032 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26033 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26034 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26035 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26036 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26037 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26039 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26040 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26041 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26042 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26045 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26046 message = Invalid sender from client host
26048 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26049 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26053 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26054 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26055 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26058 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26059 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26060 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26061 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26063 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26064 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26065 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26066 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26067 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26068 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26069 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26070 write rather ugly lines like this:
26072 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26074 Instead, all you need is
26076 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26079 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26080 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26081 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26082 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26083 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26084 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26085 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26086 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26088 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26089 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26090 in several different ways. For example:
26092 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26093 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26094 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26098 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26100 accept ...some conditions
26101 control = queue_only
26103 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26104 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26107 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26109 accept ...some conditions...
26110 control = queue_only
26111 ...some more conditions...
26113 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26114 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26115 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26119 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26120 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26123 warn ...some conditions...
26127 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26128 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26132 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26133 &%require%& verb. For example:
26135 require control = no_multiline_responses
26139 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26140 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26142 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26143 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26144 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26145 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26146 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26147 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26149 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26152 deny ...some conditions...
26155 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26156 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26159 ...some conditions...
26161 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26162 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26164 warn ...some conditions...
26170 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26171 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26172 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26173 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26174 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26175 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26176 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26180 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26181 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26182 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26183 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26184 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26185 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26186 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26189 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26190 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26191 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26192 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26194 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
26195 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26197 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26200 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26201 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26203 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26204 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26205 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26208 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26209 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26210 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26211 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26212 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26213 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26216 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26217 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26218 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26221 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26222 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26223 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26224 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26225 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26226 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26228 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26229 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26230 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26231 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26232 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26233 logging rejections.
26236 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26237 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26238 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26239 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26240 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26241 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26242 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26243 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26245 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26246 &` log_reject_target =`&
26248 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26249 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26253 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26254 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26255 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26256 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26257 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26258 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26259 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26262 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26263 &` control = freeze`&
26264 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26266 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26267 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26268 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26271 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26272 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26276 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26277 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26278 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26279 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26280 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26281 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26282 &%accept%& for details.)
26284 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26285 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26286 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26287 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26288 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26290 require message = Host not recognized
26293 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26296 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26297 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26298 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26299 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26300 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26301 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26302 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26303 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26304 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26307 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26308 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26309 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26311 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26312 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26314 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26315 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26316 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26319 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26320 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26322 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26323 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26324 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26327 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26328 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26329 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26330 However, the original message is available in the variable
26331 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26332 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26333 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26334 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26336 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26337 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26338 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26339 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26340 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26341 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26345 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26346 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26347 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26348 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26355 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26356 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26357 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26360 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26361 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26362 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26363 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26364 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26365 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26366 not work without it. For example:
26368 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26369 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26371 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26372 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26373 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26374 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26375 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26378 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26379 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26380 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26381 .cindex "case of local parts"
26382 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26383 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26384 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26385 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26386 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26387 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26390 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26391 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26392 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26393 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26394 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26396 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26397 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26400 warn control = caseful_local_part
26401 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26403 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26405 control = caselower_local_part
26407 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26408 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26411 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26412 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26413 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26414 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26415 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26416 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26417 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26418 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26419 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26423 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26424 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26425 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26429 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26430 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26431 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26432 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26433 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26434 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26435 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26436 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26438 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26439 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26440 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26441 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26442 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26443 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26447 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26448 .cindex "fake defer"
26449 .cindex "defer, fake"
26450 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26451 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26452 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26453 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26454 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26456 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26457 .cindex "fake rejection"
26458 .cindex "rejection, fake"
26459 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26460 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26461 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26462 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26463 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26464 the same SMTP connection.
26466 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26467 message is supplied, the following is used:
26469 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26470 550-kept for evaluation.
26471 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26472 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26474 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26476 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26477 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26478 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26479 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26480 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26481 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26484 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26485 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26486 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26487 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26489 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26490 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26491 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26492 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26493 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26494 disables such output flushing.
26496 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26497 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26498 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26499 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26500 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26501 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26503 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26504 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26505 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26506 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26507 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26508 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26509 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26510 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26511 to be useful in production.
26513 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26514 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26515 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26516 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26517 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26519 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26520 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26521 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26522 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26523 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26524 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26527 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26528 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26529 verification failed"&) is sent.
26531 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26535 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26536 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26538 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
26539 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
26540 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
26541 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
26542 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
26543 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
26544 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
26546 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
26547 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
26548 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
26549 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26550 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26551 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
26552 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
26553 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
26554 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
26555 same SMTP connection.
26557 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
26558 .cindex "message" "submission"
26559 .cindex "submission mode"
26560 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
26561 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
26562 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
26563 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
26564 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
26565 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
26566 late (the message has already been created).
26568 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
26569 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
26570 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
26571 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
26572 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
26574 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
26575 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
26576 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
26577 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
26578 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
26581 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
26582 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
26584 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
26586 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
26589 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
26590 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
26591 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
26592 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
26595 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26596 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26600 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26601 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26604 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26606 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26607 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26609 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26611 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26616 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26617 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26618 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26619 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26620 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26621 to an incoming message, as in this example:
26623 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26624 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26625 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26627 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26628 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26629 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26630 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26631 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26634 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26635 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26636 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26637 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26639 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26640 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26641 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26642 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26643 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26644 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26645 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26646 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26647 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26648 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26649 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26651 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26652 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26653 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26654 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26655 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26656 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26657 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26658 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26659 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26661 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26662 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26664 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26665 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
26667 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26668 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26670 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26671 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26672 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26673 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26676 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26677 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26678 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26679 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26680 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26681 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26682 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26685 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26686 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26687 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26688 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26689 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26691 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26692 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26693 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26694 to be a header name first.) For example:
26696 warn add_header = \
26697 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26699 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26700 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26701 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26702 up in reverse order.
26704 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26705 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26706 system filter or in a router or transport.
26711 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26712 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26713 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26714 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26715 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26716 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26718 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26719 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26720 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26721 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26722 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26723 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26724 The conditions are as follows:
26728 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26729 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26730 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26731 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26732 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26733 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26734 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26735 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26736 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26737 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26738 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26740 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26741 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26742 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26743 conditions are tested.
26745 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26746 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26747 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26748 for different local users or different local domains.
26750 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26751 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26752 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26753 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26754 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26755 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26756 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26761 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26762 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26763 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26764 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26765 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26766 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26767 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26768 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26769 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26770 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26771 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26772 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26775 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26776 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26777 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26778 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26779 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26780 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26781 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26782 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26784 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26785 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26786 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26787 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26788 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26790 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26791 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26792 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26793 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26794 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26795 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26796 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26797 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26798 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26799 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26801 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26802 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26803 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26804 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26805 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26806 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26807 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26808 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26809 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26812 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26813 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26816 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26817 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26818 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26819 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26820 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26821 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26822 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26828 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26829 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26830 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26831 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26832 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26833 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26834 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26836 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26838 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26839 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26840 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26842 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26843 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26844 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26845 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26846 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26847 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26849 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26850 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26852 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26853 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26855 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26856 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26857 statement can then check the IP address.
26859 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26860 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26861 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26862 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26864 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26865 message = $host_data
26867 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26869 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26870 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26871 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26872 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26873 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26874 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26875 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26876 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26877 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26878 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26880 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26881 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26882 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26883 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26884 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26885 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26886 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26888 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26889 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26890 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26891 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26892 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26893 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26894 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26897 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26898 .cindex "rate limiting"
26899 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26900 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26902 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26903 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26904 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26905 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26906 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26907 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26909 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26910 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26911 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26912 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26913 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26914 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26915 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26917 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26918 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26919 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26920 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26921 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26922 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26923 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26924 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26925 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26926 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26927 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26928 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26929 influence the sender checking.
26931 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26932 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26934 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26935 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26936 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26937 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26938 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26939 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26943 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26944 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26946 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26947 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26948 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26949 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26950 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26951 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26953 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26954 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26955 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26956 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26957 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26958 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26959 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26960 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26961 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26962 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26964 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26965 .cindex "CSA verification"
26966 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26967 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26968 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26970 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26971 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26972 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26973 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26974 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26975 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26976 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26977 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26978 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26979 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26980 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26981 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26982 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26983 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26984 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26986 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26987 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26988 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26989 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26992 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26993 !verify = header_sender
26996 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26997 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26998 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26999 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27000 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27001 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27002 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27003 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27004 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27005 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27006 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27007 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27010 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27011 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27015 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27016 common as they used to be.
27018 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27019 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27020 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27021 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27022 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27023 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27024 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27025 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27026 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27027 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27028 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27029 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27030 independently of this condition.
27032 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27033 option), this condition is always true.
27036 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27037 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27038 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27039 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27040 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27041 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27042 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27043 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27044 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27046 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27047 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27050 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27051 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27052 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27053 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27054 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27055 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27056 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27057 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27058 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27059 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27060 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27061 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27062 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27063 value for the child address.
27065 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27066 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27067 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27068 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27069 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27070 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27071 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27072 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27073 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27074 original IP address.
27076 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27077 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27079 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27080 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27081 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27082 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27083 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27084 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27085 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27086 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27087 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27089 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27090 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27091 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27092 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27093 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27094 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27095 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27097 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27098 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27099 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27101 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27102 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27103 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27104 verified as a sender.
27109 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27110 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27111 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27112 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27113 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27114 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27115 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27116 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27117 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27118 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27120 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27121 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27123 the following records are looked up:
27125 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27126 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27128 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27129 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27130 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27131 use two separate conditions:
27133 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27134 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27136 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27137 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27138 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27141 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27142 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27143 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27144 following special items in the list:
27146 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27147 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27148 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27150 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27151 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27152 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27153 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27155 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27157 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27158 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27160 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27161 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27162 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27164 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27165 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27166 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27167 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27171 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27172 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27173 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27174 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27175 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27177 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27179 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27180 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27181 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27182 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27187 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27188 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27189 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27190 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27191 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27192 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27193 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27195 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27196 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27198 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27199 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27200 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27201 up by this example is
27203 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27205 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27206 addresses. For example:
27208 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27209 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27211 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27212 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27217 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27218 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27219 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27220 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27221 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27222 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27223 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27224 either to double the separators like this:
27226 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27228 or to change the separator character, like this:
27230 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27232 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27233 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27234 occurs. Consider this condition:
27236 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27238 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27240 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27241 a.domain.black.list.tld
27243 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27244 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27245 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27246 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27247 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27248 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27249 error for a previous item.
27251 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27252 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27254 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27255 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27257 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27258 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27260 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27261 $sender_address_domain \
27262 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27264 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27265 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27266 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27268 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27269 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27270 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27271 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27273 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27275 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27276 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27278 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27279 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27284 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27285 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27286 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27287 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27288 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27289 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27293 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27295 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27296 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27297 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27299 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27300 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27301 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27304 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27305 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27306 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27307 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27308 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27309 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27310 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27311 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27312 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27313 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27314 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27315 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27316 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27317 cases, for example:
27319 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27321 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27322 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27323 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27324 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27326 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27328 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27329 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27331 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27332 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27333 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27334 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27335 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27338 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27339 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27340 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27342 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27343 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27345 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27350 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27351 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27352 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27353 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27356 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27358 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27359 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27360 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27361 describes how multiple records are handled.
27363 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27364 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27365 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27367 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27369 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27370 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27371 first. For example:
27373 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27374 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27377 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27378 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27379 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27380 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27381 tested. For example:
27383 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27385 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27386 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27387 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27389 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27391 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27396 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27397 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27400 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27402 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27403 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27405 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27407 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27408 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27409 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27410 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27412 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27413 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27415 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27416 previous example is precisely equivalent to
27418 deny dnslists = a.b.c
27419 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27421 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27422 Consider this example:
27424 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27426 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27429 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27431 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27433 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27434 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27435 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27437 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27442 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27443 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27444 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27445 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27446 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27447 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27449 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27451 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27452 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27453 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27454 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27455 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27456 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27459 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27460 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27461 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27463 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27464 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27467 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27469 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27470 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27472 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27474 for the condition to be true.
27477 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27478 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27480 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27481 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27483 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27485 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27486 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27488 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27489 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27491 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27493 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27494 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27496 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27498 for the condition to be false.
27500 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27501 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27506 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27507 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27508 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27509 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27510 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27511 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27512 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27513 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27514 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27517 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27518 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27519 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27520 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27521 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27522 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27523 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27526 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27527 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27529 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27530 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27532 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27533 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27534 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27535 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27536 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27537 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27539 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
27540 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
27541 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
27543 reject dnslists = \
27544 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
27545 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
27546 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
27547 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27549 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
27550 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
27551 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
27555 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
27556 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
27557 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
27558 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
27559 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
27560 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
27562 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
27563 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27565 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
27566 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
27567 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
27569 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
27571 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
27572 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
27574 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
27575 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
27577 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
27578 dnslists = some.list.example
27581 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
27582 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
27583 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
27584 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
27585 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
27586 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
27587 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
27588 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
27589 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
27590 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
27592 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
27594 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
27595 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27597 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27598 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27599 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27602 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27603 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27604 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27605 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27606 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27607 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27608 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27609 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27610 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27612 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27613 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27614 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27615 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27617 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27618 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27619 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27620 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27621 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27622 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27623 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27624 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27625 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27626 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27628 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27629 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27630 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27633 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
27634 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
27635 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
27636 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
27637 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
27638 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
27640 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
27641 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
27642 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
27643 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
27644 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
27645 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
27646 the &%count=%& option.
27649 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27650 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
27651 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
27652 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
27653 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
27655 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27656 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
27657 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
27658 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
27660 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
27661 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
27662 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
27663 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
27664 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
27665 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
27666 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27668 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
27669 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27670 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
27671 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
27672 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
27673 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
27674 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
27676 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
27677 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
27678 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
27679 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
27682 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27683 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
27684 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
27685 multiple different commands.
27687 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
27688 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
27689 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
27690 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
27691 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
27693 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
27696 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
27697 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
27698 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
27699 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
27700 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
27702 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
27703 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
27705 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
27706 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
27707 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
27708 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
27712 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
27713 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27714 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27717 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
27718 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27719 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27722 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
27723 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
27724 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
27725 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
27726 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
27727 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
27730 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
27731 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
27732 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
27733 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
27734 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
27737 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
27738 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
27739 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27740 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27741 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
27742 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27745 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27746 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27747 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27748 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27749 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27750 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27751 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27752 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
27753 from getting any email through.
27755 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27756 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27757 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27758 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27759 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
27760 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
27761 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
27762 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
27764 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27768 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
27769 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
27770 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
27771 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
27772 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
27773 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
27774 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
27775 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
27776 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
27778 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
27779 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
27780 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
27781 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
27782 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
27783 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
27785 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
27786 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
27789 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
27790 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
27791 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
27792 required increases with larger limits.
27794 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
27795 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
27796 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
27797 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
27798 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
27799 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
27800 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
27801 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
27802 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
27806 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27807 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27808 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27809 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27810 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27811 message. For example:
27813 # Log all senders' rates
27814 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27815 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27817 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27818 # at the decimal point.
27819 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27820 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27821 $sender_rate_limit }s
27823 # Keep authenticated users under control
27824 deny authenticated = *
27825 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27827 # System-wide rate limit
27828 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27829 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27831 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27832 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27833 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27834 messages per $sender_rate_period
27835 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27836 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27837 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27839 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27840 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27841 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27842 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27843 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27844 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27845 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27849 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27850 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27851 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27852 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27853 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27854 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27855 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27856 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27857 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27859 verify = sender/callout
27860 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27862 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27863 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27864 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27865 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27866 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27867 The available options are as follows:
27870 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27871 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27872 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27874 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27875 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27876 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27877 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27879 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27880 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27882 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27883 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27884 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27885 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27888 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27889 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27890 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27891 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27892 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27893 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27896 warn !verify = sender
27897 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27899 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27900 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27901 verification failure.
27903 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27904 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27907 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27908 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27910 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27912 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27913 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27914 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27916 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27918 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27921 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27922 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27927 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27928 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27929 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27930 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27931 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27932 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27933 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27934 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27935 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27936 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27937 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27938 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27941 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27942 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27943 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27944 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27945 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27946 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27948 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27949 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27950 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27951 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27952 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27954 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27955 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27956 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27957 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27958 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27959 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27960 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27961 supplies a host list.
27963 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27964 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27965 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27966 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27967 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27968 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27969 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27971 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27972 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27973 following SMTP commands are sent:
27975 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27977 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27980 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27983 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27984 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27985 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27986 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27987 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27988 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27990 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27991 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27992 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27993 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27994 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27996 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27997 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27998 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27999 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28000 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28005 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28006 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28007 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28008 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28010 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28012 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28013 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28014 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28018 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28019 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28020 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28023 verify = sender/callout=5s
28025 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28026 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28027 the &%connect%& parameter.
28030 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28031 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28032 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28033 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28035 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28037 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28039 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28040 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28041 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28042 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28043 updated in this circumstance.
28045 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28046 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28047 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28048 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28049 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28050 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28053 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28054 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28055 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28056 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28057 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28058 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28059 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28060 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28061 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28062 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28064 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28066 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28069 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28070 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28071 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28074 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28076 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28077 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28078 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28079 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28080 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28083 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28084 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28085 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28086 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28088 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28089 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28090 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28091 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28092 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28093 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28094 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28095 made, until the cache record expires.
28097 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28098 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28099 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28102 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28104 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28105 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28107 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28109 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28110 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28111 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28112 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28116 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28117 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28118 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28119 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28120 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28122 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28124 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28125 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28126 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28127 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28128 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28130 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28131 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28132 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28134 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28136 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28137 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28138 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28139 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28140 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28142 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28143 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28145 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28147 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28148 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28149 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28150 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28151 usefulness of callout caching.
28154 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28155 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28156 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28157 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28158 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28159 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28160 these circumstances.
28162 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28163 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28164 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28165 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28166 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28167 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28168 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28170 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28171 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28172 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28173 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28178 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28179 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28180 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28181 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28182 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28183 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28184 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28185 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28186 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28187 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28189 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28190 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28193 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28194 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28195 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28197 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28198 commands up to and including
28202 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28203 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28204 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28205 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28206 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28207 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28208 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28210 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28211 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28212 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28213 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28214 will eventually be noticed.
28216 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28217 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28218 behaviour will be the same.
28222 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28223 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28224 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28225 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28226 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28227 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28230 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28232 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28233 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28234 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28235 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28236 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28237 550 Sender verification failed
28239 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28240 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28241 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28242 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28245 verify = sender/no_details
28248 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28249 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28250 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28251 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28252 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28253 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28254 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28257 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28258 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28259 verification also fails.
28261 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28262 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28265 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28266 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28267 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28270 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28272 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28273 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28274 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28275 verification to succeed.
28277 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28278 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28279 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28280 option. For example:
28282 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28284 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28285 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28287 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28288 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28289 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28290 address and a report is output for each of them.
28294 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28295 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28296 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28297 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28298 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28299 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28300 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28304 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28305 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28306 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28307 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28308 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28309 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28311 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28312 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28313 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28314 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28317 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28319 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28321 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28322 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28324 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28325 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28328 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28329 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28331 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28333 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28334 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28335 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28336 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28339 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28341 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28342 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28343 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28345 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28346 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28347 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28348 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28349 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28350 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28351 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28352 of legitimate HELO domains.
28354 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28355 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28356 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28357 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28360 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28362 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28363 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28364 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28369 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28370 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28371 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28372 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28373 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28374 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28375 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28376 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28378 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28379 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28380 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28381 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28382 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28383 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28384 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28386 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28387 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28390 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28391 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28394 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28395 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28398 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28399 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28401 recipients = +batv_senders
28403 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28404 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28406 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28407 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28408 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28410 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28411 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28412 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28413 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28414 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28416 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28417 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28418 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28419 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28420 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28421 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28422 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28424 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28425 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28426 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28427 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28431 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28433 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28434 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28435 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28438 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28441 external_smtp_batv:
28443 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28444 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28445 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28446 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28449 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28453 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28454 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28455 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28456 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28457 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28458 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28459 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28460 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28461 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28462 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28464 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28465 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28466 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28467 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28468 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28469 same host is fulfilling both functions,
28471 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
28473 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28474 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28475 system to arbitrary domains.
28478 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28479 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28480 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28481 example, suppose you want to do the following:
28484 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28485 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28486 &'my.dom2.example'&.
28488 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28489 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28491 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28492 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28496 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28498 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28499 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28500 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28502 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28506 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28507 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28509 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28510 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28511 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28512 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28513 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28514 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28515 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28519 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28520 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28521 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28522 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28523 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28525 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28526 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28527 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28528 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28529 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28530 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28531 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28537 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28539 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
28540 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
28541 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
28542 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
28543 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
28544 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
28547 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
28548 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
28549 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
28550 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
28551 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
28553 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
28554 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
28555 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
28558 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
28559 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
28561 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
28562 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
28563 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
28565 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
28566 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
28568 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
28571 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
28574 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
28575 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
28576 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
28578 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
28579 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
28580 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
28581 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
28582 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
28583 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
28585 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
28586 temporarily created in a file called:
28588 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
28590 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
28591 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
28592 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
28593 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
28594 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
28596 control = no_mbox_unspool
28598 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
28599 same directory by default.
28603 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
28604 .cindex "virus scanning"
28605 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
28606 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
28607 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
28608 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
28609 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
28610 in memory and thus are much faster.
28613 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
28614 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
28615 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
28616 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
28618 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
28620 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
28622 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
28624 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
28625 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
28628 .vitem &%aveserver%&
28629 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28630 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
28631 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
28632 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
28635 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
28640 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
28641 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
28642 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
28643 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
28644 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
28645 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
28646 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
28648 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
28649 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
28650 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
28652 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
28653 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
28654 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
28655 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
28656 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
28657 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
28658 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
28659 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
28660 contributing the code for this scanner.
28663 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
28664 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
28665 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
28666 type takes 3 mandatory options:
28669 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28670 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28673 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28674 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28675 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28676 the &"trigger"& expression.
28679 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28680 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28681 &"name"& expression.
28684 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28686 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28688 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28689 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28690 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28691 configuration setting:
28693 av_scanner = cmdline:\
28694 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
28695 found in file:'(.+)'
28698 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
28699 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
28700 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
28701 separated by white space, as in these examples:
28703 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
28704 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
28706 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
28707 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
28710 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28711 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28712 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28714 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28716 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28717 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28719 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28720 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28721 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28722 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28723 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28726 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28728 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28731 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28732 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28733 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28734 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28735 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28736 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28737 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28739 av_scanner = mksd:2
28741 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28744 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28745 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28746 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28747 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28748 client communication. For example:
28750 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28752 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28756 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28757 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28760 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28761 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28762 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28763 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28764 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28765 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28768 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28769 use. It can then be one of
28772 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28773 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28776 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28777 the condition fails immediately.
28779 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28780 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28781 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28784 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28785 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28786 causes the ACL to defer.
28788 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28789 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28790 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28791 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28794 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28795 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28796 &%malware%& condition.
28798 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28799 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28801 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28803 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28807 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28809 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28811 malware = */defer_ok
28813 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28814 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28816 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28818 in the main Exim configuration.
28820 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28821 set acl_m0 = sophie
28824 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28825 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28830 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28831 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28832 .cindex "spam scanning"
28833 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28834 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28835 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28836 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28837 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28839 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28841 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28842 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28845 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28846 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28847 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28848 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28849 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28851 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28853 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28854 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28855 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28858 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28860 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28861 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28862 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28863 option, separated with colons:
28865 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28866 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28869 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28870 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28871 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28874 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28875 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28877 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28878 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28879 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28882 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28883 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28885 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28888 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28889 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28890 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28891 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28892 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28894 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28895 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28896 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28897 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28898 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28901 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28902 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28903 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28906 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28907 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28908 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28911 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28912 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28916 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28917 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28918 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28919 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28921 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28922 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28923 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
28924 available for use at delivery time.
28927 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28928 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28929 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28931 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28932 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28933 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28934 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28935 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
28937 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28938 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28939 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28940 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28941 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28943 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28944 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28945 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28948 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28949 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28950 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28952 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28953 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28954 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28955 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28956 spam condition, like this:
28958 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28959 spam = joe/defer_ok
28961 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28963 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28966 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28967 warn spam = nobody:true
28968 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28969 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28971 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28972 # is over threshold
28974 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28976 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28977 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28979 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28984 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28985 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28986 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28987 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28988 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28989 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28990 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28991 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28992 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28993 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28996 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28997 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28998 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28999 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29000 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29001 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29002 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29004 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29005 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29006 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29007 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29008 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29010 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29011 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29012 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29013 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29014 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29017 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29019 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29023 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29025 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29026 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29027 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29028 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29030 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29031 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29032 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29033 the full path and file name.
29035 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29036 filename, and the default path is then used.
29038 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29039 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29040 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29042 decode = $mime_filename
29044 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29045 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29046 automatically unlinked.
29048 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29049 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29050 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29051 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29052 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29054 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29055 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29056 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29058 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29059 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29060 available in the MIME ACL:
29063 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29064 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29065 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29066 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29067 contains the empty string.
29069 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29070 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29071 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29077 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29078 case-insensitively.
29080 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29081 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29082 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29083 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29084 only used for display purposes.
29086 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29087 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29088 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29090 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29091 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29092 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29094 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29095 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29096 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29097 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29098 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29100 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29101 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29102 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29103 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29105 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29106 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29107 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29108 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29112 application/octet-stream
29116 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29119 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29120 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29121 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29122 containing the decoded data.
29127 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29128 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29129 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29130 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29131 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29132 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29134 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29135 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29136 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29137 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29139 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29140 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29144 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29147 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29148 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29151 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29152 and the rest are attachments.
29155 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29158 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29159 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29160 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29162 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29163 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29164 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29165 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29167 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29168 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29169 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29170 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29171 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29173 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29174 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29175 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29176 decoding is fully recursive.
29178 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29179 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29180 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29181 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29182 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29183 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29184 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29189 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29190 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29191 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29192 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29193 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29195 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29196 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29197 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29198 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29199 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29201 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29202 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29203 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29204 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29205 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29206 32K characters are checked.
29208 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29209 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29210 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29211 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29212 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29214 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29215 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29217 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29218 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29219 matching regular expression.
29221 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29227 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29228 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29229 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29230 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29231 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29232 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29233 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29234 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29235 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29236 use the &%demime%& condition.
29238 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29239 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29240 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29241 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29242 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29243 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29245 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29246 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29249 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29250 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29252 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29253 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29254 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29255 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29257 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29258 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29259 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29261 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29264 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29265 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29266 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29267 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29268 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29269 zero, no error occurred.
29271 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29272 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29273 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29274 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29278 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29279 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29280 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29281 extension it found.
29284 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29285 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29287 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29288 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29289 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29292 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29293 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29295 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29297 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29298 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29299 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29300 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29302 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29303 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29304 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29316 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29317 "Local scan function"
29318 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29319 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29320 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29321 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29322 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29324 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29325 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29326 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29327 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29328 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29330 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29331 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29332 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29333 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29335 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29336 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29337 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29338 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29340 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29341 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29342 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29343 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29344 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29345 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29346 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29347 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29348 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29352 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29353 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29354 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29355 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29356 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29357 directory, so you might set
29359 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29361 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29362 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29363 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29364 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29365 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29366 _src/local_scan.c_.
29368 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29369 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29371 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29373 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29378 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29379 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29380 You must include this line near the start of your code:
29382 #include "local_scan.h"
29384 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29385 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29386 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29387 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29388 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29389 strings and pointers to character strings:
29391 #define CS (char *)
29392 #define CCS (const char *)
29393 #define CSS (char **)
29394 #define US (unsigned char *)
29395 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29396 #define USS (unsigned char **)
29398 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29400 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29402 The arguments are as follows:
29405 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29406 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29407 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29409 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29410 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29411 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29412 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29413 case this changes in some future version.
29415 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29416 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29419 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29422 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29423 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29424 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29425 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29426 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29427 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29429 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29430 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29431 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29433 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29434 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29435 queued without immediate delivery.
29437 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29438 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29439 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29440 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29441 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29444 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29445 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29446 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29449 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29450 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29451 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29452 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29453 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29454 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29455 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29457 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29458 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29459 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29462 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29463 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29464 &%-oe%& command line options.
29468 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29469 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29470 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29471 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29472 want to do this, you must have the line
29474 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29476 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29477 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29478 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29481 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29482 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29483 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29484 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29485 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29486 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29488 static int my_integer_option = 42;
29489 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29491 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29492 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29493 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29496 int local_scan_options_count =
29497 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29499 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29500 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29504 my_string = some string of text...
29506 The available types of option data are as follows:
29509 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
29510 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29511 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29512 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29513 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29514 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29517 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29518 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29519 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29520 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29523 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29524 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29527 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29528 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29529 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29530 printed with the suffix K or M.
29532 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
29533 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29534 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29535 always output in octal.
29537 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29538 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
29539 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
29541 .vitem &*opt_time*&
29542 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
29543 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
29546 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
29547 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
29551 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
29552 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
29553 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
29554 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
29555 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
29556 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
29557 C variables are as follows:
29560 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
29561 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
29563 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
29564 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
29566 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
29567 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
29568 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
29569 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
29572 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
29573 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
29574 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
29577 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
29578 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
29582 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
29583 selected, you should use code like this:
29585 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29586 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29588 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
29589 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
29590 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
29592 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
29593 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
29596 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
29597 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
29599 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
29600 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
29602 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
29603 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
29604 &%-bh%& command line option.
29606 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
29607 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
29608 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
29610 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
29611 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
29612 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
29613 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
29615 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
29616 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
29617 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
29619 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
29620 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
29622 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
29623 The number of accepted recipients.
29625 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
29626 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
29627 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
29628 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
29629 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
29630 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
29631 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
29632 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
29633 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
29634 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
29635 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
29636 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
29638 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
29639 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
29641 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
29642 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
29643 locally-submitted messages.
29645 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
29646 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
29647 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
29649 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
29650 The name of the sending host, if known.
29652 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
29653 The port on the sending host.
29655 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
29656 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
29658 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
29659 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
29661 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
29662 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
29663 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
29667 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
29668 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29669 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29670 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29675 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29676 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29678 .vitem &*int&~type*&
29679 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29680 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29681 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29682 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29683 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29684 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29686 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
29687 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29690 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29691 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29692 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29697 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
29698 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
29701 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
29702 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
29704 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
29705 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29706 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29707 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29709 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29710 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29711 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29712 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29713 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29714 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29715 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29716 is NULL for all recipients.
29721 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29722 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29723 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29724 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29728 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29729 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29731 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29732 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29733 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29734 for the process in &%newumask%&.
29736 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29737 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29738 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29739 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29740 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29742 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29744 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29745 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29746 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29747 return value is as follows:
29752 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29758 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29764 The process timed out.
29768 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29771 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29772 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29773 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29774 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29775 forks a subprocess that is running
29777 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29779 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29780 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29781 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29782 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29784 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29785 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29786 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29787 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29790 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29791 *sender_authentication)*&
29792 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29795 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29797 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29800 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29801 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29802 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29803 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29804 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29806 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29807 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29810 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29811 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29812 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29813 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29814 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29815 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29816 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29817 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29819 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29820 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29821 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29822 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29823 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29824 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29826 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29827 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29828 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29829 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29831 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29832 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29833 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29834 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29835 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29836 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29837 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29838 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29839 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29840 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29842 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29843 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29845 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29846 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29849 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29850 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29851 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29852 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29853 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29856 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29857 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29858 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29859 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29860 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29861 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29863 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29865 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29866 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29867 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29868 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29869 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29872 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29873 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29874 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29875 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29876 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29877 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29878 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29879 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29881 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29882 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29883 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29885 &`OK `& match succeeded
29886 &`FAIL `& match failed
29887 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29889 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29890 inability to contact a database.
29892 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29894 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29895 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29896 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29898 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29900 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29901 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29902 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29904 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29906 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29909 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29911 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29912 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29913 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29914 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29915 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29916 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29919 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29921 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29922 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29923 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29924 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29925 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29926 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29929 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29930 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29931 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29932 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29934 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29935 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29936 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29937 value afterwards. For example:
29939 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29940 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29941 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29944 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29945 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29946 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29947 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29954 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29955 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29956 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29957 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29958 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29959 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29960 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29961 binary string is returned with an error message.
29963 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29964 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29965 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29967 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29968 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29969 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29970 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29971 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29973 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29974 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29975 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29977 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29978 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29979 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29980 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29984 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29985 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29988 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29989 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29990 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29991 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29992 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29993 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29994 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29995 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29998 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29999 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30001 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30002 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30003 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30004 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30005 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30006 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30007 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30009 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30010 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30012 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30013 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30014 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30015 multiple output lines.
30017 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30018 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30019 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30020 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30021 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30022 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30023 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30026 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30027 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30028 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30029 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30031 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30032 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30033 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30035 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30038 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30041 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30042 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30043 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30044 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30045 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30046 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30052 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30053 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30054 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30055 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30056 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30057 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30058 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30061 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30062 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30063 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30064 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30066 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30067 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30069 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30071 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30072 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30073 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30074 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30076 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30077 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30078 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30079 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30086 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30087 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30089 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30090 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30091 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30092 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30093 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30094 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30095 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30096 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30098 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30099 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30100 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30101 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30102 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30104 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30105 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30106 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30107 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30108 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30109 prevent it happening on retries.
30111 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30112 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30113 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30114 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30115 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30116 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30117 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30118 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30121 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30122 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30123 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30124 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30125 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30126 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30127 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30129 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30130 system_filter_user = exim
30132 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30133 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30134 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30135 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30136 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30137 by the &%reply%& command.
30140 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30141 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30142 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30143 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30145 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30146 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30150 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30151 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30152 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30153 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30154 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30155 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30158 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30159 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30160 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30161 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30162 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30163 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30164 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30166 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30167 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30168 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30169 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30170 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30172 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30173 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30174 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30175 to which users' filter files can refer.
30179 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30180 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30181 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30182 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30183 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30187 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30188 .cindex "freezing messages"
30189 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30190 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30191 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30192 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30193 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30194 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30195 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30196 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30197 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30198 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30200 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30202 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30204 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30205 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30206 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30207 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30208 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30211 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30212 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30213 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30214 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30216 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30217 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30218 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30219 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30220 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30221 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30222 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30223 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30224 message. For example:
30226 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30227 because it contains attachments that we are \
30228 not prepared to receive."
30231 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30232 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30233 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30234 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30235 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30236 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30239 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30240 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30242 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30243 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30244 generated by the filter.
30246 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30248 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30249 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30255 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30256 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30261 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30262 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30263 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30264 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30265 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30267 headers add <string>
30268 headers remove <string>
30270 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30271 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30272 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30273 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30274 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30276 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30277 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30278 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30281 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30282 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30285 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30286 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30287 space after input continuations is ignored.
30289 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30290 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30291 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30292 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30293 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30295 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30296 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30297 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30298 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30299 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30300 used for all recipients of the message.
30302 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30303 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30304 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30305 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30306 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30307 until the message is actually being written (see section
30308 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30310 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30311 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30312 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30313 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30314 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30315 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30316 modified more than once.
30318 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30319 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30322 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30323 headers remove "Subject"
30324 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30325 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30330 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30331 .cindex "envelope sender"
30332 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30334 errors_to <some address>
30336 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30337 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30338 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30341 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30343 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30344 address if its delivery failed.
30348 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30349 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30350 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30351 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30352 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30353 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30354 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30355 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30356 which implements such a filter:
30361 domains = +local_domains
30362 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30367 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30368 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30369 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30370 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30372 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30373 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30374 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30375 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30377 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
30378 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
30379 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
30386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30389 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30390 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30391 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30392 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30393 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30394 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30395 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30396 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30398 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30399 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30400 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30401 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30402 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30404 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30405 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30406 loopback interface specially in any way.
30408 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30409 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30414 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30415 .cindex "message" "submission"
30416 .cindex "submission mode"
30417 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30418 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30419 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30420 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30422 control = submission
30424 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30425 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30426 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30427 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30428 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30429 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30431 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30432 control = submission
30434 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30435 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30436 is used to separate options. For example:
30438 control = submission/sender_retain
30440 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30441 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30442 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30443 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30444 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30445 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30446 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30448 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30449 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30452 control = submission/domain=some.domain
30454 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30455 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30456 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30457 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30459 accept authenticated = *
30460 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30461 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30462 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30464 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30465 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30466 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30468 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30470 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30473 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30475 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30476 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30477 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30478 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30480 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30481 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30482 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30483 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30484 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30485 spoof another's address.
30487 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30488 .cindex "line endings"
30489 .cindex "carriage return"
30491 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30492 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30493 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30494 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30495 use CRLF or just CR.
30497 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30498 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30499 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30500 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30501 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30502 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30503 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30504 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30508 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30510 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30513 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30514 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30517 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30518 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30519 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30520 people trying to play silly games.
30522 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30523 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30531 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30532 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
30533 .cindex "address" "qualification"
30534 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30535 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30536 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30537 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30538 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
30540 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
30541 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
30542 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
30543 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
30544 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
30546 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
30547 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
30548 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
30549 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
30550 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
30551 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
30552 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
30553 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
30558 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
30559 .cindex "&""From""& line"
30560 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
30561 .cindex "sender" "address"
30562 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
30563 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
30564 .cindex "envelope sender"
30565 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30566 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
30567 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
30568 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
30570 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
30571 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
30573 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
30574 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
30575 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
30576 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
30577 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
30578 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
30579 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
30580 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
30581 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
30583 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
30584 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
30585 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
30586 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
30587 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
30588 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
30589 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
30591 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
30592 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
30593 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
30595 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
30596 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
30597 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
30598 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
30602 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
30603 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
30604 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
30605 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
30606 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
30607 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
30608 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
30611 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
30612 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
30615 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
30616 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
30620 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
30621 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
30623 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
30624 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
30625 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
30627 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
30630 For a locally-submitted message,
30631 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
30632 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
30633 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
30634 included in log lines in this case.
30636 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
30637 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
30643 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
30644 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
30645 includes the header line:
30647 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
30650 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
30651 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
30652 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
30653 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
30654 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
30655 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
30658 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
30659 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
30660 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
30661 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
30662 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
30664 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
30665 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
30666 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
30667 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
30668 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30669 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30670 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30671 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30675 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30676 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30677 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30678 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30679 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30680 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30681 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30682 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30686 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30687 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30688 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30689 .cindex "message" "submission"
30690 .cindex "submission mode"
30691 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30692 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30695 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
30696 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
30698 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30699 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
30701 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30702 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30703 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30705 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30706 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30708 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30709 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30713 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30715 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30716 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30717 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30718 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30719 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30720 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30721 &%qualify_domain%&.
30723 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30724 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30725 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30726 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30729 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30730 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30731 .cindex "message" "submission"
30732 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30733 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30734 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30735 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30736 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30737 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30738 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30739 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30740 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30741 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30744 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30745 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30746 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30747 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30748 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30750 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30751 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30752 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30753 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30755 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30756 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30757 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30760 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30761 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30762 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30763 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30764 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30765 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30766 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30767 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30768 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30769 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30770 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30774 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30775 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30776 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30777 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30778 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30779 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30780 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30781 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30785 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30786 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30787 .cindex "message" "submission"
30788 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30789 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30790 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30791 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30794 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30795 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30796 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30797 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30798 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30799 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30800 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30801 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30802 line is added to the message.
30804 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30805 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30806 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30807 options true at the same time.
30809 .cindex "submission mode"
30810 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30811 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30812 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30813 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30815 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30816 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30817 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30818 created as follows:
30821 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30822 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30823 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30825 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30826 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30828 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30829 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30832 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30833 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30834 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30835 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30837 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30838 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30839 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30840 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30844 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30845 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30846 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30847 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30848 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30849 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30850 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30851 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30852 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30854 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30855 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30856 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30857 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30858 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30859 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30861 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30862 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30863 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30865 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30866 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30867 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30869 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30870 X-added-second: another added header line
30872 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30874 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30875 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30876 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30877 not part of the names. For example:
30879 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30881 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30882 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30883 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30884 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30885 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30887 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30888 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30889 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30890 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30892 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30893 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30894 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30897 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30898 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30899 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30900 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30901 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30902 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30903 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30905 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30906 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30907 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30908 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30910 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30911 the following consequences:
30914 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30915 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30916 to it, at all times.
30918 Header lines that are added by a router's
30919 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30920 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30922 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30923 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30925 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30926 a later router or by a transport.
30928 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30929 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30931 headers_remove = subject
30932 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30936 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30937 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30943 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30944 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30945 .cindex "constructed address"
30946 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30949 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30953 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30955 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30956 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30957 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30958 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30959 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30960 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30961 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30962 there is no password file entry.
30965 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30966 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30967 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30968 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30969 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30970 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30971 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30972 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30976 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30977 .cindex "case of local parts"
30978 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30979 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30980 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30981 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30982 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30983 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30984 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30987 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30988 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30989 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30990 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30991 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30995 domains = +local_domains
30996 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30997 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31000 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31001 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31002 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31003 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31004 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31008 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31009 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31010 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31011 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31012 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31013 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31014 empty components for compatibility.
31018 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31019 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31020 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31021 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31022 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31023 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31025 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31026 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31027 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31028 example, a header such as
31032 might get rewritten as
31034 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31036 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31037 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31040 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31041 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31042 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31043 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31044 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31045 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31046 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31053 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31054 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31055 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31056 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31057 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31058 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31059 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31062 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31064 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31066 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31069 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31072 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31074 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31077 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31080 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31081 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31084 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31085 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31086 used to contain the envelope information.
31090 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31091 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31092 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31093 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31094 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31097 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31098 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31099 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31100 processing is the same in both cases.
31102 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31103 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31104 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31105 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31106 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31107 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31108 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31109 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31112 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31113 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31114 required for the transaction.
31116 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31117 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31118 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31120 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31121 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31122 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31124 .cindex "carriage return"
31126 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31127 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31128 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31131 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31132 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31133 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31134 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31135 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31136 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31137 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31138 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31139 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31141 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31142 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31143 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31144 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31146 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31147 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31148 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31149 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31151 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31152 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31153 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31154 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31155 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31156 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31157 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31158 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31159 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31160 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31162 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31163 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31165 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31166 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31167 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31168 square bracket of the IP address.
31173 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31174 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31175 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31176 .cindex "host" "error"
31177 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31178 message errors, and recipient errors.
31181 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31182 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31183 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31186 Connection refused or timed out,
31188 Any error response code on connection,
31190 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31192 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31194 I/O errors at any time,
31196 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31197 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31200 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31201 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31202 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31203 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31204 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31205 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31206 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31207 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31209 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31210 .cindex "message" "error"
31211 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31212 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31213 message errors are:
31216 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31219 Timeout after MAIL,
31221 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31222 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31223 connection at any other time.
31226 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31227 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31228 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31229 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31230 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31231 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31232 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31233 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31234 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31235 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31237 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31238 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31239 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31242 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31243 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31244 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31245 recipient errors are:
31248 Any error response to RCPT,
31250 Timeout after RCPT.
31253 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31254 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31255 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31256 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31257 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31258 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31259 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31260 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31261 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31262 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31263 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31264 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31265 the retry clock is reset.
31267 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31268 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31269 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31270 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31271 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31272 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31273 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31274 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31275 recipient's retry time.
31278 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31279 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31280 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31281 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31282 until the next delivery attempt.
31284 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31285 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31286 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31287 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31288 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31291 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31292 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31293 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31294 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31295 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31296 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31297 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31299 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31300 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31301 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31302 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31303 then to be treated as a host error.
31305 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31306 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31307 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31308 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31309 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31314 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31315 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31316 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31319 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31320 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31321 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31323 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31325 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31326 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31327 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31328 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31329 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31330 stream and exits with an error code.
31332 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31333 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31334 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31335 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31337 .cindex "carriage return"
31339 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31340 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31341 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31343 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31344 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31345 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31347 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31348 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31349 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31350 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31351 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31352 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31353 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31354 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31356 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31357 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31358 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31359 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31360 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31361 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31362 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31363 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31364 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31366 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31367 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31368 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31370 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31371 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31372 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31373 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31374 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31376 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31377 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31378 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31379 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31380 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31381 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31382 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31384 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31385 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31386 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31387 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31388 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31390 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31391 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31392 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31393 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31394 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31395 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31396 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31397 a delivery process.
31399 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31400 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31401 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31402 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31403 however, available with &'inetd'&.
31405 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31406 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31407 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31408 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31410 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31411 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31412 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31416 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31417 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31418 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31419 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31420 the error response to the last command. The default value for
31421 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31422 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31423 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31426 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31427 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31428 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31429 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31430 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31431 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31432 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31433 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31434 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31435 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31436 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31440 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31441 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31442 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31443 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31444 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31445 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31446 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31447 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31449 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31450 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31451 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31452 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31453 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31456 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31457 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31458 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31460 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31461 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31462 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31463 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31464 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31469 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31470 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31471 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31472 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31473 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31475 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31476 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31477 called with the &%-bv%& option.
31479 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31480 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31481 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31482 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31483 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31484 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31485 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31490 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31491 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31492 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31493 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31494 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31495 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31496 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31498 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31499 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31500 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31501 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31502 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31503 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31504 argument. For example,
31512 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31513 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31514 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31515 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31516 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31518 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31519 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31520 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31521 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31522 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31523 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31524 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31525 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31527 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31528 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31529 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31530 whatever the form of its argument. For
31533 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31534 $sender_host_address
31536 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31537 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31538 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
31539 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
31540 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
31541 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
31542 for it to change them before running the command.
31546 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
31547 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
31548 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
31549 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
31550 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
31551 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
31552 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
31553 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
31554 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
31555 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
31556 runs for RCPT commands:
31560 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
31564 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
31565 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
31566 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
31567 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
31568 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
31569 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
31570 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
31571 envelope along with the message.
31573 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
31574 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
31575 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
31576 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
31577 can be used to specify it.
31579 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
31580 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
31581 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
31582 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
31583 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
31586 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
31587 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
31588 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
31593 driver = manualroute
31594 transport = smtp_appendfile
31595 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
31599 driver = appendfile
31600 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
31605 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
31606 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
31607 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
31611 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
31612 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
31613 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
31614 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
31615 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
31616 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
31617 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
31618 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
31619 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
31620 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
31622 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
31623 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
31625 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
31626 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
31627 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
31628 make some use of automatically, for example:
31630 554 Unexpected end of file
31631 Transaction started in line 10
31632 Error detected in line 14
31634 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
31637 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
31638 The error message was:
31640 501 '>' missing at end of address
31642 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
31643 The error was detected in line 12.
31644 The SMTP command at fault was:
31646 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
31648 1 previous message was successfully processed.
31649 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
31651 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
31652 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
31654 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
31655 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
31659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31662 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
31663 "Customizing messages"
31664 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
31665 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
31666 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
31667 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
31668 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31670 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31671 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31672 option. Exim also adds the line
31674 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31676 to all warning and bounce messages,
31679 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31680 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31681 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31682 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31683 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31684 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31685 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31687 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31688 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31689 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31690 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31691 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31694 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
31695 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
31696 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
31697 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
31698 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
31699 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
31700 option, rounded to a whole number.
31702 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
31705 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31706 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31708 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31709 failing addresses with their error messages.
31711 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31712 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31714 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31715 as part of the error report.
31717 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31718 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31720 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31723 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31724 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31725 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31727 Subject: Mail delivery failed
31728 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31729 {: returning message to sender}}
31731 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31733 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31734 {that you sent }{sent by
31738 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31739 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31741 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31743 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31746 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31748 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31751 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31752 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31753 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31754 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31755 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31759 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31760 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31762 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31763 the delayed addresses.
31765 The third item then ends the message.
31768 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31769 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31771 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31772 $warn_message_delay
31774 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31776 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31777 {that you sent }{sent by
31781 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31782 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31784 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31785 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31786 The date of the message is: $h_date
31788 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31790 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31791 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31792 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31793 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31794 the message will be returned to you.
31796 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31797 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31798 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31799 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31800 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31801 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31802 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31803 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31812 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31813 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31814 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31818 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31819 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31820 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31821 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31822 routing explicitly:
31824 send_to_smart_host:
31825 driver = manualroute
31826 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31827 transport = remote_smtp
31829 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31830 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31831 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31832 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31833 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31838 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31839 .cindex "mailing lists"
31840 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31841 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31842 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31844 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31845 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31846 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31847 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31851 domains = lists.example
31852 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31855 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31858 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31859 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31860 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31861 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31863 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31864 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31867 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31868 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31869 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31870 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31871 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31873 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31874 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31875 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31876 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31877 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31878 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31879 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31880 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31881 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31885 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31886 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31887 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31888 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31889 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31890 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31891 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31893 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31894 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31895 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31896 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31897 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31901 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31902 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31903 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31904 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31905 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31906 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31907 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31908 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31909 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31910 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31912 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31913 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31914 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31915 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31916 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31917 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31918 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31919 pre-existing messages.
31921 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31922 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31923 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31924 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31925 one level of expansion anyway.
31929 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31930 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31931 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31932 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31933 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31934 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31936 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31937 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31941 domains = lists.example
31942 local_part_suffix = -request
31943 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31948 domains = lists.example
31949 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31950 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31951 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31954 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31959 domains = lists.example
31961 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31963 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31964 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31965 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31968 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31969 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31970 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31971 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31972 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31973 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31974 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31975 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31976 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31978 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31979 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31980 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31985 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31987 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31988 .cindex "envelope sender"
31989 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31990 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31991 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31992 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31993 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31994 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31996 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31997 .oindex &%return_path%&
31998 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31999 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32000 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32001 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32002 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32003 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32004 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32010 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32011 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32013 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32014 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32015 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32016 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32017 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32018 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32019 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32022 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32024 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32025 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32026 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32027 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32028 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32029 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32031 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32032 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32033 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32034 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32038 domains = ! +local_domains
32040 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32041 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32044 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32045 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32046 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32047 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32050 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32051 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32052 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32053 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32054 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32058 domains = ! +local_domains
32059 transport = remote_smtp
32061 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32062 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32065 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32066 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32067 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32068 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32071 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32072 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32073 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32074 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32075 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32076 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32084 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32085 .cindex "virtual domains"
32086 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32087 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32091 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32092 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32093 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32095 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32096 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32097 have login accounts on that host.
32100 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32101 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32102 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32103 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32104 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32105 to a router of this form:
32109 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32110 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32113 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32114 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32115 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32116 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32117 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32118 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32120 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32121 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32122 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32123 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32125 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32126 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32127 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32131 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32132 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32133 transport = my_mailboxes
32135 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32136 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32137 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32138 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32139 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32143 driver = appendfile
32144 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32147 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32148 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32150 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32151 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32152 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32153 information about the domains.
32157 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32158 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32159 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32160 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32161 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32162 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32163 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32164 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32165 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32166 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32167 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32168 example, consider this router:
32173 file = $home/.forward
32174 local_part_suffix = -*
32175 local_part_suffix_optional
32178 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32179 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32180 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32181 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32183 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32184 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32187 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32188 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32189 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32190 control over which suffixes are valid.
32192 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32193 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32199 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32200 local_part_suffix = -*
32201 local_part_suffix_optional
32204 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32205 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32206 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32207 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32208 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32212 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32213 .cindex "vacation processing"
32214 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32215 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32216 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32217 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32218 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32221 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32222 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32223 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32224 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32226 spqr, vacation-spqr
32229 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32230 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32231 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32232 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32233 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32237 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32238 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32242 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32243 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32244 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32245 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32246 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32247 each day's messages.
32249 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32250 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32251 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32252 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32256 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32257 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32258 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32259 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32260 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32261 permanently connected.
32263 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32264 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32265 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32268 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32269 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32270 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32271 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32272 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32273 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32274 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32275 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32277 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32278 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32279 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32280 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32281 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32282 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32285 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32286 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32287 intermittent host. For example:
32289 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32291 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32292 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32293 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32294 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32295 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32296 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32299 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32300 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32301 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32302 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32303 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32304 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32305 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32309 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32310 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32311 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32312 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32313 delivered immediately.
32315 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32316 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32317 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32318 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32319 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32320 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32321 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32322 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32323 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32324 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32325 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32326 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32327 single SMTP connection.
32331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32334 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32335 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32336 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32337 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32338 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32339 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32340 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32341 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32342 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32343 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32346 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32347 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32348 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32349 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32350 email is not desirable.
32352 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32353 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32354 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32355 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32356 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32357 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32358 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32360 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32361 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32362 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32363 before sending a message to the smart host.
32365 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32366 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32367 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32369 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32370 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32371 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32372 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32373 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32374 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32375 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32377 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32381 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32382 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32384 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32385 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32386 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32387 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32388 successful, a zero return code is given.
32390 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32391 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32392 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32393 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32394 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32397 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32398 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32399 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32401 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32402 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32403 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32404 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32405 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32407 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32408 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32409 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32411 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32412 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32413 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32414 are ever generated.
32416 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32418 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32419 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32420 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32423 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32424 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32425 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32426 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32427 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32428 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32436 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32437 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32438 .cindex "log" "types of"
32439 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32444 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32445 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32446 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32447 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32448 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32449 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32450 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32451 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32453 .cindex "reject log"
32454 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32455 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32456 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32457 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32458 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32459 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32460 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32461 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32462 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32465 .cindex "panic log"
32466 .cindex "system log"
32467 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32468 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32469 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32470 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32471 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32472 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32473 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32474 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32475 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32478 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32479 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32480 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32482 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32485 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32486 ways of changing this:
32489 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32494 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32496 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32499 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32503 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32504 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32505 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32506 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32507 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32508 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32513 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32514 .cindex "log" "destination"
32515 .cindex "log" "to file"
32516 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
32518 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32519 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32520 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32521 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32522 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32523 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32524 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32526 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32527 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32528 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32529 references to the host name:
32531 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32533 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32534 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32535 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32536 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32537 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32540 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
32541 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
32542 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
32543 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
32544 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
32545 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
32546 implying the use of a default path.
32548 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
32549 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
32550 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
32551 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
32552 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
32553 equivalent to the setting:
32555 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
32557 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
32560 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
32561 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
32563 Here are some examples of possible settings:
32565 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
32566 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
32567 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
32568 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
32570 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
32575 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
32576 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32577 .cindex "cycling logs"
32578 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32579 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
32580 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
32581 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
32582 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
32583 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
32584 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
32586 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
32587 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
32588 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
32589 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
32590 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
32591 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
32592 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
32593 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
32594 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
32595 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
32596 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
32601 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
32602 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
32603 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
32604 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
32605 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
32606 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
32607 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
32608 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
32610 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
32611 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
32612 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
32613 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
32615 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
32616 examples of names generated by the above examples:
32618 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
32619 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
32620 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
32621 /var/log/exim/main.200212
32623 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
32624 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
32625 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
32626 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
32628 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
32629 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
32630 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
32631 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
32632 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
32633 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
32636 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32637 /var/log/exim-panic.log
32638 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32639 /var/log/exim/panic
32643 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
32644 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
32645 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
32646 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
32647 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
32648 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
32649 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
32650 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
32651 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
32652 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
32653 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
32654 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
32655 the time and host name to each line.
32656 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
32659 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
32661 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
32663 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
32666 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
32667 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
32668 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
32669 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
32671 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
32672 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32673 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32674 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32675 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32676 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32677 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32678 RFC 3164, you should set
32680 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32682 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32683 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32685 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32686 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32687 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32688 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32689 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32690 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32691 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32692 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32693 name, and pid as added by syslog:
32695 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
32696 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
32697 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
32698 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
32701 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
32704 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
32705 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
32706 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
32707 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
32709 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32710 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32711 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32712 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32713 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32714 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
32716 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32717 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
32718 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32721 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32723 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32724 without modification.
32726 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32727 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32728 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32733 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32734 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32735 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32736 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32737 timestamp. The flags are:
32739 &`<=`& message arrival
32740 &`=>`& normal message delivery
32741 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
32742 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32743 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32744 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32748 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32749 .cindex "log" "reception line"
32750 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32751 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32752 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32754 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32755 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32756 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32758 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32759 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32760 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32764 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32768 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32769 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32770 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32771 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32772 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32773 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32774 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32775 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32776 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32777 name in parentheses.
32779 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32780 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32781 the log containing text like these examples:
32783 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32784 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32786 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32789 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32790 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32793 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32794 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32795 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32796 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32797 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32798 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32799 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32800 suite that was used.
32802 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32803 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32804 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32805 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32806 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32807 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32808 authenticator name.
32810 .cindex "size" "of message"
32811 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32812 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32813 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32814 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32817 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32818 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32822 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32823 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32824 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32825 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32826 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32827 to fit it on the page:
32829 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32830 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32831 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32832 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32833 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32835 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32836 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32837 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32838 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32839 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32841 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32842 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32844 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32846 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32847 parentheses afterwards.
32849 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32850 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32851 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32852 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32853 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32854 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32856 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32857 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32859 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32860 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32863 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32864 .cindex "discarded messages"
32865 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32866 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32867 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32868 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32870 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32871 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32873 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32874 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32876 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32877 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32881 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32882 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32884 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32885 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32887 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32888 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32889 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32891 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32892 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32894 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32895 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32896 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32900 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32901 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32902 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32903 following form is logged:
32905 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32906 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32908 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32909 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32911 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32912 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32913 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32914 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32915 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32917 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32918 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32919 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32920 flagged with &`**`&.
32924 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32925 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32926 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32927 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32928 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32932 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32935 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32937 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32938 at the end of its processing.
32943 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32944 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32945 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32946 the following table:
32948 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32949 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32950 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32951 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32952 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32953 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32954 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32955 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32956 &`H `& host name and IP address
32957 &`I `& local interface used
32958 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32959 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32960 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32961 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32962 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32963 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32964 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32965 &`S `& size of message
32966 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32967 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32968 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32969 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32970 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32974 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32975 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32976 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32979 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32980 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32981 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32982 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32983 during the first delivery attempt.
32985 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32986 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32987 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32989 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32990 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32991 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32992 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32993 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32996 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32997 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33000 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33001 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33003 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33004 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33006 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33007 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33008 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33012 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33020 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33021 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33022 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33023 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33024 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33027 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33029 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33030 selection marked by asterisks:
33032 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33033 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33034 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33035 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33036 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33037 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33038 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33039 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33040 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33041 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33042 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33043 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33044 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33045 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33046 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33047 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33048 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33049 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33050 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33051 &` pid `& Exim process id
33052 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33053 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33054 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33055 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33056 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33057 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33058 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33059 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33060 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33061 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33062 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33063 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33064 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33065 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33066 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33067 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33068 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33069 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33070 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33071 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33073 &` all `& all of the above
33075 More details on each of these items follows:
33078 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33079 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33080 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33081 this log selector is set.
33083 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33084 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33085 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33086 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33087 such users cannot access the log).
33089 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33090 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33091 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33092 parentheses between them.
33094 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33095 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33096 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33097 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33098 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33099 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33100 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33101 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33102 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33103 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33104 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33105 between the caller and Exim.
33107 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33108 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33109 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33111 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33112 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33113 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33114 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33115 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33116 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33118 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33119 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33120 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33122 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33123 .cindex "size" "of message"
33124 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33125 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33127 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33128 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33129 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33130 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33131 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33133 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33134 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33135 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33136 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33137 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33138 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33140 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33141 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33142 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33143 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33144 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33146 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33147 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33148 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33149 client's ident port times out.
33151 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33152 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33153 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33154 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33155 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33156 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33159 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33160 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33161 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33162 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33163 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33164 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33165 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33166 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33167 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33168 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33169 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33171 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33172 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33173 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33175 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33176 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33177 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33178 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33179 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33180 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33181 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33183 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33184 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33185 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33186 immediately after the time and date.
33188 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33189 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33190 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33192 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33193 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33194 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33195 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33196 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33197 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33198 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33199 message has been successfully received.
33201 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33202 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33203 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33204 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33206 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33207 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33208 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33209 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33210 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33212 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33215 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33216 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33217 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33218 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33220 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33221 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33222 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33223 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33224 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33226 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33227 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33228 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33229 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33232 .cindex "log" "return path"
33233 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33234 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33235 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33236 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33238 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33239 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33240 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33241 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33242 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33244 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33245 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33246 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33247 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33250 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33251 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33254 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33255 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33256 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33257 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33259 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33260 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33262 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33263 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33264 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33265 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33266 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33269 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33270 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33271 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33272 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33273 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33274 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33275 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33276 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33277 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33278 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33280 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33281 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33282 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33283 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33284 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33285 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33286 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33287 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33289 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33290 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33291 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33292 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33293 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33294 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33296 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33297 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33298 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33299 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33300 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33301 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33302 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33303 already have their own log lines.
33305 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33306 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33307 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33308 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33309 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33310 the same logging options.
33312 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33313 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33317 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33318 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33319 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33320 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33321 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33323 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33324 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33325 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33326 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33327 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33328 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33329 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33330 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33332 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33333 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33334 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33335 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33336 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33337 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33338 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33339 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33340 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33342 .cindex "log" "subject"
33343 .cindex "subject, logging"
33344 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33345 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33346 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33347 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33348 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33350 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33351 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33352 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33353 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33355 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33356 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33357 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33358 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33360 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33361 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33362 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33363 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33364 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33366 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33367 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33368 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33372 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
33373 .cindex "message" "log file for"
33374 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33375 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33376 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33377 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33378 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33379 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33380 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33381 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33382 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33383 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33384 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33386 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33387 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33388 &%message_logs%& option false.
33394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33397 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33398 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33399 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33400 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33401 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33403 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33404 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33405 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33406 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33407 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33408 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33409 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33411 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33412 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33413 "extract statistics from the log"
33414 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33415 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33416 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33417 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33418 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33419 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33420 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33421 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33424 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33425 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33426 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33431 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33432 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33433 .cindex "process, querying"
33435 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33436 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33437 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33438 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33439 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33440 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33441 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33442 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33444 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33445 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33446 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33449 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33450 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33451 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33452 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33453 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33456 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33457 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33458 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33459 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33461 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33463 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
33464 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
33465 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33466 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
33467 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
33468 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33470 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33471 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33475 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33476 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33477 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
33478 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33482 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33483 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33484 options are available:
33487 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33488 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33489 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33493 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33494 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33497 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33498 Match against the size field.
33500 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33501 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33503 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33504 Match messages that are older than the given time.
33507 Match only frozen messages.
33510 Match only non-frozen messages.
33513 The following options control the format of the output:
33517 Display only the count of matching messages.
33520 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33524 Display message ids only.
33527 Brief format &-- one line per message.
33530 Display messages in reverse order.
33533 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
33537 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
33538 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
33539 .cindex "queue" "summary"
33540 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
33541 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
33542 running a command such as
33544 exim -bp | exiqsumm
33546 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
33547 it, as in the following example:
33549 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
33551 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
33552 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
33553 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
33554 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
33556 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
33557 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
33558 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
33559 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
33560 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
33561 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
33564 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
33565 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
33566 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
33567 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
33568 level"& addresses).
33573 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
33575 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
33576 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
33577 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
33578 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
33579 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
33580 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
33581 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
33582 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
33583 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
33584 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
33586 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
33588 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
33590 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
33591 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
33592 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
33594 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
33595 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
33596 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
33597 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
33598 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
33600 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
33601 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
33602 regular expression.
33604 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
33605 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
33607 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
33608 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
33609 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
33612 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
33613 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
33614 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
33615 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
33616 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
33617 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
33618 the &%--help%& option.
33621 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
33622 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33623 .cindex "cycling logs"
33624 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33625 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
33626 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
33627 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
33628 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
33629 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
33630 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
33632 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
33633 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
33635 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
33636 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
33637 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
33641 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
33642 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
33643 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
33644 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
33645 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
33646 logs are handled similarly.
33648 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
33649 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
33650 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
33651 any existing log files.
33653 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
33654 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
33655 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
33656 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
33657 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
33659 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
33661 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
33662 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
33666 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
33667 .cindex "statistics"
33668 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
33669 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
33670 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
33671 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
33672 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33674 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33675 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33676 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33677 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33678 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33680 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33682 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33683 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33684 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33685 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33686 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33687 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
33688 also produced per user.
33690 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
33691 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
33692 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
33693 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
33694 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
33696 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
33697 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
33698 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
33699 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
33700 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
33701 an entirely separate message.
33703 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
33704 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
33705 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
33706 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
33707 least one address that failed.
33709 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33710 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33711 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33712 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33713 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33714 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33715 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33717 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33718 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33719 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33721 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33722 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33723 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33725 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33728 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33729 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33730 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33731 .cindex "checking access"
33732 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33733 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33734 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33735 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33736 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33737 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33739 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33740 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33742 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33744 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33745 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33746 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33747 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33750 550 Relay not permitted
33752 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33753 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33754 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33755 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33758 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33759 -f himself@there.example
33761 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33762 mandatory arguments.
33764 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33765 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33766 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33770 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33771 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33772 .cindex "building DBM files"
33773 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33774 .cindex "lower casing"
33775 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33776 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33777 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33778 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33779 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33780 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33782 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33783 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33784 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33785 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33788 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33789 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33790 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33794 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33795 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33796 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33797 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33799 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33801 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33802 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33804 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33805 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33806 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33807 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33808 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33809 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33811 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33812 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33813 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33814 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33815 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33816 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33817 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33823 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33824 .cindex "retry" "times"
33825 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33826 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33827 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33828 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33829 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33830 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33831 output. For example:
33833 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33834 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33835 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33836 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33837 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33838 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33839 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33840 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33841 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33842 past final cutoff time
33844 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33845 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33846 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33847 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33848 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33849 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33852 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33853 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33854 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33855 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33856 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33857 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33861 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33862 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33863 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33864 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33865 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33866 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33867 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33870 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33872 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33875 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33877 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33879 &'misc'&: other hints data
33882 The &'misc'& database is used for
33885 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33887 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33888 &(smtp)& transport)
33893 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33894 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33895 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33896 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33897 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33899 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33901 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33903 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33904 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33906 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33907 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33908 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33909 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33910 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33911 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33912 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33913 and a textual description of the error.
33915 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33916 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33917 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33920 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33921 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33922 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33923 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33924 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33925 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33930 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33931 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33932 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33933 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33934 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33935 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33936 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33937 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33938 updated sufficiently often.
33940 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33941 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33942 the retry database:
33944 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33946 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33947 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33948 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33949 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33950 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33951 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33952 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33953 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33954 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33955 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33956 whenever it removes information from the database.
33958 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33959 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33960 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33961 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33962 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33964 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33965 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33966 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33967 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33968 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33969 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33970 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33973 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33974 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33979 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33980 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33981 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33982 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33983 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33984 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33985 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33988 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33989 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33990 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33991 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33992 by new data, for example:
33996 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33997 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33998 used as optional separators.
34003 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34004 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34005 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34006 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34007 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34008 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34009 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34010 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34011 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34012 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34013 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34014 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34015 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34019 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34022 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34025 .vitem &%-interval%&
34026 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34027 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34029 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34030 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34033 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34036 Suppress verification output.
34038 .vitem &%-retries%&
34039 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34040 the lock (default 10).
34042 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34043 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34044 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34045 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34048 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34049 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34050 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34051 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34054 Generate verbose output.
34057 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34058 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34059 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34060 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34061 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34062 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34063 more than 30 minutes old.
34065 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34066 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34067 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34068 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34069 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34070 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34072 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34073 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34074 suppresses all output except error messages.
34078 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34080 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34082 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34083 <&'some commands'&>
34086 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34087 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34090 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34091 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34093 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34094 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34099 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34101 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34102 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34103 .cindex "X-windows"
34104 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34105 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34106 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34107 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34108 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34109 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34110 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34111 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34115 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34116 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34117 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34118 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34119 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34120 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34121 parameters are for.
34123 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34124 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34125 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34127 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34129 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34130 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34131 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34132 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34133 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34135 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34136 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34138 Eximon*background: gray94
34140 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34141 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34142 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34143 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34144 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34145 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34146 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34149 Eximon*highlight: gray
34152 .cindex "admin user"
34153 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34154 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34156 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34157 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34158 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34159 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34160 different parts of the display.
34165 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34166 .cindex "stripchart"
34167 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34168 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34169 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34170 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34171 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34172 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34173 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34174 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34175 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34177 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34178 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34179 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34180 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34182 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34183 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34184 to a single partition.
34186 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34187 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34188 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34189 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34190 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34191 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34192 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34197 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34198 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34199 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34200 .cindex "window size"
34201 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34202 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34203 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34204 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34205 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34206 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34208 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34209 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34210 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34211 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34213 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34214 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34215 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34216 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34217 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34218 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34220 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34221 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34222 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34226 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34227 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34228 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34229 the main log is maintained.
34230 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34231 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34232 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34233 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34234 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34236 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34237 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34238 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34239 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34240 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34241 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34242 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34243 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34244 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34245 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34246 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34248 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34249 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34250 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34251 It cannot go further back up the log.
34253 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34254 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34255 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34256 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34257 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34258 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34260 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34261 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34262 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34263 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34264 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34265 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34267 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34268 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34269 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34270 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34271 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34272 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34273 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34274 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34275 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34280 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34281 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34282 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34283 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34284 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34285 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34286 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34287 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34288 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34289 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34291 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34292 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34293 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34294 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34295 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34296 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34297 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34299 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34300 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34301 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34302 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34303 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34304 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34305 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34307 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34308 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34309 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34310 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34312 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34313 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34314 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34315 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34316 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34317 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34318 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34321 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34322 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34324 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34325 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34326 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34327 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34328 display is updated.
34332 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34333 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34334 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34335 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34336 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34339 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34340 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34341 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34342 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34343 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34345 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34347 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34351 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34352 in a new text window.
34354 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34355 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34356 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34358 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34359 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34360 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34361 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34363 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34364 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34365 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34366 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34367 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34369 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34370 that the message be frozen.
34372 .cindex "thawing messages"
34373 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
34374 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34375 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34376 that the message be thawed.
34378 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34379 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34380 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34381 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34383 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34384 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34387 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34388 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34389 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34390 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34391 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34392 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34393 which case no action is taken.
34395 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34396 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34397 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34398 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34399 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34400 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34401 case no action is taken.
34403 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34404 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34406 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34407 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34408 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34409 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34410 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34411 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34412 the address is qualified with that domain.
34415 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34416 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34417 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34418 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34419 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34420 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34421 if no output is generated.
34423 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34424 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34425 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34426 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34428 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34429 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34430 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34440 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34441 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34442 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34443 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34445 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34446 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34447 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34448 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34449 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34450 its security as compared with other MTAs.
34452 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34453 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34454 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34455 as soon as possible.
34458 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34459 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
34460 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34461 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34462 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34463 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34466 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34467 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34468 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34469 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34470 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34471 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34473 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34474 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34475 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34476 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34479 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34480 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34481 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34482 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34483 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34484 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34485 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34486 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34487 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34491 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34492 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34493 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34494 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34495 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34496 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34497 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34499 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34502 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34503 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34504 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34505 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34506 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34511 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34513 .cindex "root privilege"
34514 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34515 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34516 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34517 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34518 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34519 is required for two things:
34522 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34523 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34526 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
34527 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
34531 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
34532 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
34533 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
34534 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
34535 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
34536 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
34537 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
34538 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
34540 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
34541 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
34542 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
34544 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
34545 uid and gid in the following cases:
34550 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
34551 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
34552 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
34553 the calling process.
34554 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
34555 option may not be used at all.
34556 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
34557 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
34558 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
34563 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
34564 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
34567 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
34568 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
34569 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
34570 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
34571 testing address verification
34574 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
34577 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
34578 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
34581 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
34584 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
34585 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
34586 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
34587 will be used during message reception.
34589 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
34590 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
34592 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
34593 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
34594 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
34595 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
34596 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
34597 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
34598 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
34599 generating bounce and warning messages.
34601 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
34602 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
34603 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
34604 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
34606 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
34607 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
34613 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
34614 .cindex "privilege, running without"
34615 .cindex "unprivileged running"
34616 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
34617 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
34618 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
34619 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
34620 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
34621 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
34622 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
34626 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
34627 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
34628 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
34629 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
34631 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
34632 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
34633 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
34634 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
34635 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
34637 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
34638 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
34639 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
34642 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
34643 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
34644 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
34646 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
34647 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
34648 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
34649 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
34650 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
34651 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
34652 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
34653 address this problem at this time.
34655 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
34656 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
34657 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
34658 be used in the most straightforward way.
34660 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
34661 number of restrictions on what you can do:
34664 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
34665 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
34666 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
34667 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
34668 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
34670 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
34671 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
34673 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
34674 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
34675 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
34676 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
34678 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
34679 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
34682 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
34683 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
34684 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
34686 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
34687 owned by the Exim user.
34689 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
34690 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
34691 mailboxes need to be created manually.
34696 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
34697 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
34698 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
34699 gives more security at essentially no cost.
34701 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
34702 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
34707 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
34708 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
34709 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
34713 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
34714 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
34715 .cindex "IP source routing"
34716 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
34717 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
34718 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
34719 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34723 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34724 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34725 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34730 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34731 .cindex "trusted users"
34732 .cindex "admin user"
34733 .cindex "privileged user"
34734 .cindex "user" "trusted"
34735 .cindex "user" "admin"
34736 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34737 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34738 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34739 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34740 permit a remote host to be specified.
34743 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34744 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34745 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34746 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34747 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34748 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34750 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34751 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34752 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34753 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34754 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34756 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34757 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34758 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34759 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34760 includes the contents of files on the spool.
34764 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34765 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34766 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34767 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34768 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34769 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34771 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34772 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34773 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34774 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34775 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34776 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34781 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34782 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34783 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34784 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34785 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34786 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34790 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34791 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34792 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34793 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34794 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34799 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34800 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34801 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34802 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34807 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34808 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34809 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34810 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34811 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34815 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
34816 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
34817 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
34821 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34822 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34823 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34824 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34825 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34826 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34827 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34829 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34830 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34835 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34836 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34837 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34838 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34842 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34843 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34844 enough to hold the result.
34845 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34853 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34854 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34855 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34856 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34857 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34858 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34859 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34860 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34861 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34862 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34863 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34864 themselves are recoverable.
34866 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34867 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34868 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34871 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34872 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34873 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34874 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34875 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34877 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34878 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34879 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34880 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34881 will always be the case.
34883 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34885 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34888 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34890 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34891 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34892 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34893 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34894 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34895 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34896 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34897 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34900 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34901 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34902 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34903 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34904 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34905 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34906 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34907 normally the Exim user.
34909 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34910 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34911 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34912 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34913 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34914 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34915 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34916 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34918 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34919 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34920 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34921 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34923 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34924 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34927 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34928 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34929 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34930 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34931 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34932 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34933 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34934 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34935 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34938 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34939 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34940 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34941 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34942 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34943 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34945 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34946 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34947 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34948 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34949 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34950 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34952 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34953 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34954 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34956 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34957 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34958 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34959 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34960 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34962 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34963 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34964 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34965 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34966 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34968 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34969 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34970 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34972 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34973 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34974 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34976 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34977 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34980 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34981 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34982 present if the number is greater than zero.
34984 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34985 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34986 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34988 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34989 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34990 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34992 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34993 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34996 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34997 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34998 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35001 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35002 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35003 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35004 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35006 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35007 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35008 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35010 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35011 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35012 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35013 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35014 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35015 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35017 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35018 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35019 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35020 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35021 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35023 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35024 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35025 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35026 generated messages.
35029 The message is from a local sender.
35031 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35032 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35034 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35035 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35036 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35037 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35039 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35040 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35041 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35044 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35045 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35048 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35049 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35050 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35052 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35053 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35054 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35056 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35057 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35058 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35060 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35061 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35062 certificate was verified by the server.
35064 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35065 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35066 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35068 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35069 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35070 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35074 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35075 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35076 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35077 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35078 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35079 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35080 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35081 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35082 addresses are complete.
35084 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35085 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35086 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35087 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35088 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35089 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35091 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35092 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35093 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35095 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35096 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35097 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35098 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35102 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35103 darcy@austen.fict.example
35105 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35107 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35108 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35109 line is of the following form:
35111 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35112 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35114 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35115 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35116 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35117 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35118 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35119 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35120 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35121 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35124 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35125 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35126 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35127 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35128 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35132 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35133 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35134 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35135 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35136 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35137 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35138 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35139 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35140 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35141 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35144 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35145 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35146 typical set of headers:
35148 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35149 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35150 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35151 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35152 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35153 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35154 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35155 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35156 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35157 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35158 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35160 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35161 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35162 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35163 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35164 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35165 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35170 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
35174 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35175 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35177 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35179 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35180 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35182 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35183 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35184 different signature contexts.
35187 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35188 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35189 Exim's standard controls.
35191 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35192 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35193 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35194 signature status. Here is an example:
35196 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35198 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35199 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35200 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35201 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35205 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35206 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35208 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35209 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35211 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35213 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35214 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35216 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35218 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35219 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35220 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35221 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35223 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35225 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35226 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35227 The result can either
35229 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35231 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35234 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35235 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35239 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35241 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35242 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35243 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35244 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35246 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35248 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35249 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35250 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35251 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35254 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35256 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35257 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35258 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35262 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35263 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35265 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35266 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35267 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35269 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35270 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35271 runtime of the ACL.
35273 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35274 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35275 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35276 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35278 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35279 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35280 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35281 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35282 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35283 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35286 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35288 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35289 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35290 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35292 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35294 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35295 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35296 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35298 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35301 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35302 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35305 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35306 available (from most to least important):
35310 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35311 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35312 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35313 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35314 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35315 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35317 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35318 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35320 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35321 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35323 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35324 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35326 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35328 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35329 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35330 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35332 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35333 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35335 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35336 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35338 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35339 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35340 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35342 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35343 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35344 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35345 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35347 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35348 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35349 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35350 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35351 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35352 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35353 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35354 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35355 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35356 The key record selector string.
35357 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35358 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35359 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35360 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35361 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35362 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35363 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35364 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35365 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35366 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35367 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35368 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35369 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35370 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35371 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35372 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35373 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35374 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35375 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35376 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35377 integer size comparisons against this value.
35378 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35379 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35380 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35381 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35382 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35383 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35384 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35385 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35387 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35388 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35390 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35391 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35394 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35397 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35398 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35399 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35400 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35401 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35404 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
35405 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35406 sender_domains = gmail.com
35407 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35411 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
35412 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35413 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35414 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
35417 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
35418 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35419 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35420 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35423 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35424 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35425 for more information of what they mean.
35428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35431 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35432 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35433 .cindex "adding drivers"
35434 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
35435 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35436 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35437 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35440 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35441 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35443 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35445 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35447 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35448 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35449 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35451 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35453 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35456 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35457 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35459 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35460 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35461 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35463 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35466 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35467 as for other drivers and lookups.
35470 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35471 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35472 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35473 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35474 searched using a binary chop procedure.
35476 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35477 the interface that is expected.
35482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35483 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35485 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35486 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35487 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35488 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35490 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35495 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35496 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35500 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
35501 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35502 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35505 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35506 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////